1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.91"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
457 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
458 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
460 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
495 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496 .cindex "bug reports"
497 .cindex "reporting bugs"
498 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
505 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
510 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
512 &*https://downloads.exim.org/*&
514 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
517 The content served at &'https://downloads.exim.org/'& is identical to the
518 content served at &'https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim'& and
519 &'ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim'&.
521 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524 here are top-level directories.
526 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
529 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
536 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
538 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541 most portable to old systems.
543 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
545 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
551 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
555 At time of last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
566 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
567 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
570 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
575 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
580 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
584 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
586 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
587 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
594 .cindex "domainless addresses"
595 .cindex "address" "without domain"
596 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
602 .cindex "transport" "external"
603 .cindex "external transports"
604 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
611 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
616 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620 a number of common scanners are provided.
624 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
625 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
632 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
640 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
641 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
645 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
652 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653 .cindex "terminology definitions"
654 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657 below) by a blank line.
659 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666 rise to further bounce messages.
668 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
673 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
678 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
682 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
683 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
684 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
691 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
693 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
699 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
700 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
701 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
702 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
705 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
712 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
713 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
716 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
717 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
718 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
722 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
728 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
743 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744 .cindex "incorporated code"
745 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
748 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
751 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
758 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763 following statements:
766 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
768 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
772 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776 restrictions applied to it).
779 .cindex "SPA authentication"
780 .cindex "Samba project"
781 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
788 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793 conditions expressed therein.
796 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
798 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
803 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
806 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
811 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814 details, please contact
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
824 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
827 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
830 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
841 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
844 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
850 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
855 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861 software without specific, written prior permission.
863 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
873 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
881 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
883 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
893 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
897 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898 .cindex "design philosophy"
899 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
907 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
909 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
911 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
916 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
927 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
930 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
935 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
941 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
945 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947 runs at the start of every delivery process.
952 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
953 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
954 .cindex "Sieve filter"
955 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960 of filtering are available:
963 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
966 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
970 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
974 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976 .cindex "format" "of message id"
977 .cindex "id of message"
982 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
989 not always case-sensitive.
991 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
1000 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003 way of representing the date and time of day).
1005 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006 received the message.
1008 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1010 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1016 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018 (1/100) of a second.
1022 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1029 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030 .cindex "receiving mail"
1031 .cindex "message" "reception"
1032 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035 there are several possibilities:
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1049 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1055 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1062 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1070 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074 users to change sender addresses.
1076 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1081 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1084 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089 message is received.
1095 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1104 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113 affect file system performance.
1115 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1121 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1136 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137 .cindex "message" "life of"
1138 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1139 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1146 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1153 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1159 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1160 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1166 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1171 .cindex "journal file"
1172 .cindex "file" "journal"
1173 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1182 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1183 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186 deliveries caused by crashes.
1190 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1198 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1200 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1202 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208 the driver's features in general.
1210 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1216 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1223 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1230 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1235 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1237 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243 configured to fail the address.
1245 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1252 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257 the address is bounced.
1261 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1263 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1270 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1275 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1282 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283 .cindex "router" "running details"
1284 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1286 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1293 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295 original address ceases,
1296 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1303 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1309 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1311 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1315 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1321 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1325 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1330 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1334 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1340 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344 facility for this purpose.
1347 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348 .cindex "case of local parts"
1349 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1354 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355 routed addresses are shown.
1359 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1367 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1368 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1369 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1370 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1371 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1372 of any other conditions.
1374 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1375 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1376 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1378 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1379 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1380 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1381 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1382 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1384 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1385 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1386 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1387 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1388 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1390 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1391 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1392 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1394 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1395 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1397 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1398 of domains that it defines.
1400 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1402 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1690 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 file name is used unmodified.
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1753 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1754 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1757 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1758 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1759 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1760 operates on a single file.
1764 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1765 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1766 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1767 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1768 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1772 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1773 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1775 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1776 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1777 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1778 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1779 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1780 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1782 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1783 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1784 in one of these lines:
1789 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1790 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1791 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1792 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1795 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1796 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1798 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1799 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1803 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1804 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1805 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1806 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1807 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1808 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1809 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1810 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1811 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1812 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1813 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1814 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1816 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1817 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1818 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1819 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1820 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1821 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1823 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1824 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1825 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1826 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1827 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1828 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1831 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1832 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1833 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1834 facilities, you need to set
1836 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1838 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1839 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1842 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1843 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1844 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1845 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1846 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1847 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1848 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1850 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1851 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1852 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1853 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1854 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1859 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1860 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1862 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1863 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1864 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1865 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1866 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1867 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1868 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1870 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1871 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1872 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1873 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1874 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1878 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1882 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1883 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1884 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1885 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1886 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1887 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1888 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1889 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1890 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1891 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1894 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1895 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1898 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1901 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1903 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1904 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1907 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1908 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1910 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1911 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1914 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1916 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1917 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1921 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1923 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1924 library and include files. For example:
1928 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1929 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1931 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1932 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1936 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1939 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1940 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1941 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1946 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1948 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1949 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1950 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1951 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1952 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1953 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1954 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1955 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1956 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1957 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1958 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1959 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1962 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1963 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1964 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1966 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1967 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1969 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1971 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1972 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1973 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1974 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1975 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1976 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1980 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1981 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1982 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1983 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1984 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1985 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1988 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1989 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1990 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1991 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1992 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1994 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1999 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2000 .cindex "lookup modules"
2001 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2002 .cindex ".so building"
2003 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2004 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2006 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2007 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2009 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2011 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2012 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2013 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2014 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2015 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2016 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2018 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2019 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2020 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2029 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2030 .cindex "build directory"
2031 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2032 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2033 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2034 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2035 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2036 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2037 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2039 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2040 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2041 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2042 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2043 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2044 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2045 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2046 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2048 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2049 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2050 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2054 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2055 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2056 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2057 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2058 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2059 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2060 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2064 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2065 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2066 given in addition to the short output.
2070 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2071 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2072 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2073 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2074 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2075 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2076 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2079 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2080 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2083 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2084 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2085 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2087 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2088 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2089 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2090 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2091 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2092 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2093 and are often not needed.
2095 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2096 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2097 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2098 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2099 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2100 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2101 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2102 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2103 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2106 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2107 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2108 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2109 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2113 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2114 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2115 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2116 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2117 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2118 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2119 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2120 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2121 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2122 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2123 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2124 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2125 containing the lines
2130 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2131 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2133 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2134 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2135 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2138 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2140 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2141 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2142 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2143 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2144 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2145 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2146 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2147 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2153 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2154 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2155 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2156 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2157 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2158 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2159 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2160 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2163 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2164 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2165 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2166 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2167 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2168 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2169 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2170 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2171 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2172 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2173 syntax. For instance:
2176 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2178 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2179 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2180 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2183 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2184 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2185 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2189 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2190 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2192 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2193 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2194 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2195 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2196 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2197 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2200 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2201 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2203 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2204 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2207 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2208 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2210 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2211 definition of all three of these variables into your
2212 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2215 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2216 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2217 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2218 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2220 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2221 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2222 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2223 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2224 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2227 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2228 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2229 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2230 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2231 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2234 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2236 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2237 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2238 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2239 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2240 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2241 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2245 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2246 .cindex "building Eximon"
2247 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2248 where the files that are involved are
2250 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2251 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2254 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2255 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2257 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2258 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2260 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2261 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2262 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2263 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2267 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2268 .cindex "installing Exim"
2269 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2270 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2271 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2272 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2273 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2274 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2275 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2276 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2277 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2278 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2279 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2280 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2282 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2283 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2284 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2285 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2286 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2287 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2288 alternative files, no default is installed.
2290 .cindex "system aliases file"
2291 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2292 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2293 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2294 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2295 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2296 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2297 and outputs a comment to the user.
2299 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2300 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2301 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2302 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2303 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2305 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2306 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2307 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2308 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2309 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2312 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2313 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2316 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2318 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2319 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2320 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2321 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2322 but this usage is deprecated.
2324 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2325 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2326 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2327 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2328 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2329 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2331 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2332 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2333 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2334 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2335 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2336 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2337 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2339 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2340 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2341 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2344 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2346 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2347 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2348 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2349 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2352 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2354 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2355 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2358 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2359 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2361 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2365 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2367 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2369 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2370 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2371 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2373 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2378 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2379 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2380 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2381 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2382 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2385 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2386 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2387 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2391 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2392 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2393 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2394 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2395 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2401 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2402 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2403 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2404 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2405 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2409 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2410 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2411 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2412 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2413 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2418 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2420 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2422 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2423 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2424 user agent. For example:
2426 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2427 From: user@your.domain.example
2428 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2429 Subject: Testing Exim
2431 This is a test message.
2434 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2435 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2436 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2438 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2439 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2440 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2441 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2442 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2443 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2445 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2447 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2448 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2449 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2450 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2451 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2453 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2454 .cindex "lock files"
2455 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2456 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2457 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2458 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2459 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2460 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2461 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2462 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2463 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2464 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2465 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2466 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2468 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2469 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2470 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2471 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2472 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2475 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2476 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2477 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2478 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2482 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2483 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2484 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2485 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2486 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2487 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2488 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2489 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2490 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2491 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2492 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2493 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2494 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2496 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2497 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2498 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2499 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2500 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2501 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2504 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2506 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2507 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2509 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2510 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2511 favourite user agent.
2513 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2514 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2515 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2516 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2517 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2518 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2522 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2523 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2524 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2525 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2526 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2527 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2528 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2529 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2535 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2536 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2537 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2539 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2541 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2542 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2543 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2544 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2545 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2547 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2549 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2551 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2552 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2553 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2561 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2562 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2563 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2564 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2565 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2566 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2567 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2568 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2569 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2572 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2574 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2575 were present before any other options.
2576 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2578 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2579 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2580 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2583 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2584 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2585 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2589 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2590 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2591 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2594 .cindex "queue runner"
2595 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2596 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2597 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2599 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2600 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2601 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2602 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2603 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2604 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2605 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2606 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2609 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2610 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2611 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2612 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2613 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2614 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2617 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2618 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2619 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2620 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2621 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2622 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2624 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2625 .cindex "envelope sender"
2626 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2627 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2628 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2629 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2630 users to set envelope senders.
2632 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2633 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2634 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2635 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2636 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2637 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2638 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2640 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2641 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2642 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2643 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2644 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2645 that are available to trusted users.
2647 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2648 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2649 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2650 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2651 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2653 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2654 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2655 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2656 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2658 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2659 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2660 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2661 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2663 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2664 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2669 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2670 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2671 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2677 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2678 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2679 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2680 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2681 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2682 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2683 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2684 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2687 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2688 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2689 . creates a man page for the options.
2690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2693 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2700 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2701 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2702 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2703 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2706 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2707 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2708 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2711 .vitem &%--version%&
2712 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2713 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2720 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2723 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2725 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2726 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2727 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2728 clean; it ignores this option.
2733 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2734 .cindex "queue runner"
2735 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2736 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2737 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2739 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2740 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2741 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2742 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2744 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2745 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2746 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2747 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2749 When a listening daemon
2750 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2751 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2752 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2753 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2754 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2755 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2758 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2759 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2760 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2764 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2765 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2766 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2767 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2768 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2769 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2770 because these are reread each time they are used.
2774 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2775 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2779 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2780 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2781 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2782 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2783 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2784 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2786 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2787 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2788 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2789 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2790 test data. A line history is supported.
2792 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2793 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2794 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2795 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2796 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2797 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2798 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2800 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2801 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2802 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2803 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2805 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2806 defined and macros will be expanded.
2807 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2808 available to admin users.
2810 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2812 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2813 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2814 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2815 of a file. For example:
2817 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2819 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2820 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2821 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2822 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2823 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2824 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2825 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2828 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2830 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2831 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2832 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2833 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2834 system filters are recognized.
2836 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2838 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2839 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2840 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2841 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2842 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2843 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2844 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2845 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2848 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2849 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2850 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2852 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2854 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2855 variables that are used by the user filter.
2857 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2862 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2863 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2864 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2867 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2868 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2869 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2870 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2872 When testing a filter file,
2873 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2874 .cindex "envelope sender"
2875 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2876 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2877 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2878 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2879 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2882 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2884 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2885 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2886 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2889 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2891 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2892 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2893 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2894 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2895 actually being delivered.
2897 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2899 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2900 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2903 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2905 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2906 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2909 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2911 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2912 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2913 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2914 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2915 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2916 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2917 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2918 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2919 after a full stop. For example:
2921 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2922 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2924 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2925 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2926 conversion to the canonical form is
2927 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2929 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2930 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2931 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2932 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2933 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2937 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2938 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2939 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2942 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2943 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2944 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2946 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2947 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2948 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2949 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2950 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2951 session were authenticated.
2953 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2954 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2955 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2957 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2958 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2959 specialized SMTP test program such as
2960 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2962 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2964 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2965 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2966 updating the callout cache database.
2970 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2971 .cindex "building alias file"
2972 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2973 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2974 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2975 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2976 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2979 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2980 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2981 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2982 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2983 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2984 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2987 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2989 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2990 .cindex "querying exim information"
2991 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2992 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2993 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2994 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2995 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2998 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2999 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3000 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3001 recognised DSCP names.
3003 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3004 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3005 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3006 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3007 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3008 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3009 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3010 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3011 way to guarantee a correct response.
3015 .cindex "local message reception"
3016 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3017 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3018 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3019 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3020 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3021 if no other conflicting option is present.
3023 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3024 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3025 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3026 suppressing this for special cases.
3028 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3029 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3031 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3032 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3033 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3036 .cindex "message" "format"
3037 .cindex "format" "message"
3038 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3039 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3040 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3041 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3042 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3044 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3045 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3047 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3048 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3049 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3050 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3051 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3053 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3054 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3055 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3056 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3057 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3059 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3060 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3061 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3062 .cindex "malware scan test"
3063 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3064 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3065 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3066 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3067 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3068 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3069 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3071 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3072 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3073 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3074 This option requires admin privileges.
3076 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3077 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3078 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3082 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3083 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3084 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3085 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3086 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3087 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3088 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3090 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3091 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3092 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3093 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3094 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3096 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3097 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3098 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3099 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3104 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3105 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3106 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3107 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3108 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3109 arguments, for example:
3111 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3113 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3114 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3115 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3116 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3117 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3118 users, the output is as in this example:
3120 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3122 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3123 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3125 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3126 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3127 backward compatibility.)
3128 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3129 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3131 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3132 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3133 name will not be output.
3135 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3136 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3137 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3138 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3139 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3140 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3141 written directly into the spool directory.
3143 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3145 exim -bP +local_domains
3147 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3148 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3150 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3151 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3152 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3153 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3154 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3155 that driver are output. For example:
3157 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3159 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3160 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3161 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3162 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3163 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3166 .cindex "environment"
3167 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3168 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3171 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3172 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3173 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3174 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3175 The output format is one item per line.
3176 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3177 the exit status will be nonzero.
3181 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3182 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3183 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3184 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3185 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3186 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3187 to allow any user to see the queue.
3189 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3191 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3192 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3195 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3196 .cindex "size" "of message"
3197 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3198 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3199 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3200 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3201 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3202 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3203 before the sender address.
3205 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3206 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3207 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3209 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3210 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3211 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3212 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3213 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3219 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3220 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3221 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3227 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3228 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3229 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3230 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3235 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3236 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3237 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3238 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3242 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3246 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3251 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3252 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3253 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3254 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3259 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3260 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3261 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3262 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3263 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3265 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3266 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3268 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3269 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3270 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3271 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3272 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3273 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3274 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3275 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3276 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3278 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3279 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3284 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3285 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3286 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3287 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3288 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3289 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3290 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3294 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3295 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3296 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3297 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3298 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3299 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3300 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3301 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3302 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3304 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3305 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3306 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3308 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3309 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3310 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3311 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3313 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3314 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3315 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3317 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3318 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3319 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3320 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3321 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3323 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3324 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3328 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3329 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3330 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3331 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3332 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3333 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3334 messages to the MTA.
3337 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3338 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3339 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3340 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3341 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3342 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3343 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3347 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3348 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3349 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3350 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3351 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3352 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3353 the listening daemon.
3357 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3358 .cindex "address" "testing"
3359 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3360 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3361 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3362 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3363 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3365 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3366 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3368 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3369 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3372 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3373 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3374 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3375 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3376 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3379 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3380 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3381 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3382 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3384 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3385 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3386 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3387 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3390 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3391 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3393 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3394 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3395 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3396 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3397 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3398 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3403 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3404 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3405 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3406 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3407 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3408 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3410 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3411 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3412 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3413 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3414 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3415 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3416 dynamic testing facilities.
3420 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3421 .cindex "address" "verification"
3422 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3423 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3424 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3425 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3426 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3427 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3429 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3430 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3431 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3433 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3434 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3436 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3437 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3440 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3441 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3442 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3443 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3444 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3446 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3447 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3448 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3449 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3450 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3451 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3454 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3455 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3456 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3459 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3460 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3461 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3462 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3464 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3465 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3466 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3467 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3471 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3472 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3479 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3480 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3481 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3482 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3484 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3485 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3486 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3487 each port only when the first connection is received.
3489 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3490 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3492 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3494 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3495 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3496 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3497 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3498 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3499 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3500 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3501 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3502 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3504 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3505 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3506 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3507 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3508 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3509 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3510 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3511 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3512 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3514 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3515 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3516 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3517 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3518 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3519 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3520 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3522 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3523 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3524 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3525 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3526 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3527 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3528 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3530 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3531 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3532 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3535 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3536 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3537 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3538 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3539 specified by this option.
3542 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3544 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3545 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3546 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3547 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3548 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3549 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3551 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3552 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3553 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3554 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3555 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3556 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3557 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3559 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3560 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3561 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3567 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3568 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3571 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3573 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3574 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3577 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3579 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3580 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3581 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3582 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3583 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3584 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3585 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3588 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3589 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3590 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3591 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3592 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3593 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3594 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3597 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3598 &`auth `& authenticators
3599 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3600 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3601 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3602 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3603 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3604 &`filter `& filter handling
3605 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3606 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3607 &`ident `& ident lookup
3608 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3609 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3610 &`load `& system load checks
3611 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3612 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3613 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3614 &`memory `& memory handling
3615 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3616 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3617 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3618 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3619 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3620 &`retry `& retry handling
3621 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3622 &`route `& address routing
3623 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3625 &`transport `& transports
3626 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3627 &`verify `& address verification logic
3628 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3630 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3631 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3632 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3633 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3634 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3635 turn everything off.
3637 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3638 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3639 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3640 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3641 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3644 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3645 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3646 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3647 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3648 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3651 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3652 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3655 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3656 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3658 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3660 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3661 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3662 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3663 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3666 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3667 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3668 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3669 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3673 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3674 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3675 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3676 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3677 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3678 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3679 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3680 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3683 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3684 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3685 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3686 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3687 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3689 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3691 .cindex "sender" "name"
3692 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3693 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3694 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3695 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3696 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3697 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3699 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3701 .cindex "sender" "address"
3702 .cindex "address" "sender"
3703 .cindex "trusted users"
3704 .cindex "envelope sender"
3705 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3706 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3707 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3708 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3711 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3712 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3713 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3714 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3717 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3718 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3719 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3720 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3721 examples of shell commands:
3723 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3724 exim -f "" user@domain
3726 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3727 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3730 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3731 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3732 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3733 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3736 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3737 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3738 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3739 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3740 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3741 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3745 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3746 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3748 control = suppress_local_fixups
3750 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3751 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3754 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3757 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3759 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3760 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3761 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3766 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3767 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3768 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3769 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3770 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3771 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3773 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3775 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3776 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3777 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3778 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3779 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3780 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3782 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3784 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3786 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3787 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3788 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3789 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3790 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3791 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3792 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3795 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3796 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3797 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3798 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3799 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3800 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3802 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3803 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3804 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3805 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3807 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3809 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3810 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3811 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3812 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3813 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3814 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3815 can be used only by an admin user.
3817 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3818 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3820 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3821 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3822 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3823 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3824 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3825 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3826 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3827 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3833 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3837 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3839 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3841 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3843 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3844 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3845 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3849 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3850 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3851 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3855 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3856 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3857 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3859 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3863 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3864 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3865 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3866 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3870 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3871 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3872 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3877 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3879 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3881 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3883 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3884 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3885 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3886 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3888 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3890 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3891 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3892 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3893 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3894 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3895 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3896 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3897 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3898 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3899 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3900 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3901 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3902 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3904 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3906 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3907 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3908 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3909 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3910 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3911 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3912 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3913 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3915 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3917 .cindex "freezing messages"
3918 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3919 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3920 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3921 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3922 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3923 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3926 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3928 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3929 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3930 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3931 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3932 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3933 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3934 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3935 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3938 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3940 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3941 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3942 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3943 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3944 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3946 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3948 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3949 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3950 .cindex "removing recipients"
3951 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3952 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3953 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3954 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3955 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3956 can be used only by an admin user.
3958 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3960 .cindex "removing messages"
3961 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3962 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3963 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3964 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3965 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3966 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3967 placed on the queue.
3969 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3971 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3972 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3973 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3974 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3975 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3976 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3977 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3978 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3979 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3981 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3983 .cindex "thawing messages"
3984 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3985 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3986 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3987 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3988 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3989 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3992 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3994 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3995 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3996 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3997 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3999 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4001 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4002 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4003 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4004 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4005 only by an admin user.
4007 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4009 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4010 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4011 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4012 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4013 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4015 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4017 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4018 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4019 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4020 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4024 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4025 treats it that way too.
4029 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4030 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4031 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4032 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4033 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4034 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4035 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4038 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4039 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4040 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4041 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4042 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4043 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4044 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4049 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4050 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4051 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4052 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4054 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4056 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4059 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4061 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4062 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4063 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4066 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4068 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4069 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4070 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4071 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4072 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4073 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4077 .cindex "background delivery"
4078 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4079 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4080 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4081 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4082 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4083 processes to finish.
4085 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4086 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4087 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4088 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4090 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4091 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4092 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4093 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4097 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4098 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4099 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4100 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4101 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4102 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4104 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4105 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4108 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4109 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4111 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4112 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4113 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4114 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4119 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4124 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4125 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4126 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4127 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4128 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4129 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4130 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4131 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4132 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4133 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4138 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4139 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4140 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4141 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4142 configuration file is in effect.
4144 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4145 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4146 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4147 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4148 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4149 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4150 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4151 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4152 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4157 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4158 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4159 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4162 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4164 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4165 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4166 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4167 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4171 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4172 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4173 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4174 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4175 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4179 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4180 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4181 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4182 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4183 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4187 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4188 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4193 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4194 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4199 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4200 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4201 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4202 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4203 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4204 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4207 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4208 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4210 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4212 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4213 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4214 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4215 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4216 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4217 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4219 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4220 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4222 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4224 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4225 followed by a colon and the port number:
4227 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4229 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4230 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4231 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4232 whichever one is last.
4234 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4236 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4238 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4239 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4240 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4241 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4243 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4245 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4246 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4247 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4248 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4249 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4250 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4252 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4254 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4255 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4256 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4257 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4258 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4259 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4260 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4261 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4263 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4265 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4266 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4267 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4268 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4269 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4271 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4273 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4274 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4275 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4276 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4277 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4278 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4279 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4281 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4282 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4283 is sending the bounce.
4285 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4287 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4288 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4289 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4290 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4291 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4292 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4293 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4294 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4295 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4296 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4298 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4300 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4301 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4302 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4303 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4304 uses the name it is given.
4306 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4308 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4309 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4310 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4311 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4312 used, when there is no default.
4316 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4317 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4318 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4319 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4323 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4324 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4325 whatever that means.
4327 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4329 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4330 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4331 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4332 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4333 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4334 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4335 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4337 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4339 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4340 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4341 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4342 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4343 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4345 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4347 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4348 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4349 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4350 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4351 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4352 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4356 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4358 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4360 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4361 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4362 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4363 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4364 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4365 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4366 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4367 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4371 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4372 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4373 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4374 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4379 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4380 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4381 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4382 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4385 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4387 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4389 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4391 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4392 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4393 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4394 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4395 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4396 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4400 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4401 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4402 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4403 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4404 and &%-S%& options).
4406 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4407 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4408 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4409 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4410 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4411 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4412 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4415 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4416 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4417 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4418 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4419 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4422 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4423 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4424 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4425 this to be repeated periodically.
4427 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4428 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4429 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4430 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4432 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4433 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4434 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4436 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4437 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4438 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4439 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4443 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4444 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4445 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4446 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4447 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4448 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4451 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4452 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4453 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4454 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4455 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4456 delivered down a single SMTP
4457 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4458 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4459 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4460 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4461 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4464 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4466 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4467 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4468 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4469 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4470 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4472 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4474 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4475 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4476 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4477 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4478 their retry times are tried.
4480 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4482 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4483 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4486 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4488 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4489 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4490 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4493 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4496 .cindex "named queues"
4497 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4498 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4499 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4500 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4501 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4502 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4504 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4505 will specify a queue to operate on.
4508 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4510 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4513 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4514 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4515 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4516 starting message id. For example:
4518 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4520 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4521 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4522 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4524 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4526 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4527 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4528 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4529 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4530 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4531 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4533 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4534 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4535 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4536 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4537 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4538 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4539 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4540 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4541 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4543 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4545 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4546 process every 30 minutes.
4548 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4549 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4551 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4553 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4556 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4558 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4560 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4562 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4563 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4564 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4565 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4566 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4567 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4568 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4570 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4571 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4572 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4573 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4574 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4575 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4577 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4578 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4580 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4582 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4583 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4584 applied to each queue run.
4586 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4587 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4588 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4589 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4590 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4591 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4592 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4593 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4594 address will be skipped.
4596 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4597 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4598 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4601 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4602 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4603 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4604 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4605 an arbitrary command instead.
4609 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4611 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4613 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4614 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4615 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4616 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4617 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4618 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4620 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4622 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4623 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4624 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4628 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4629 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4630 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4631 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4632 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4633 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4634 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4635 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4636 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4638 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4639 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4640 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4641 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4642 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4643 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4644 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4645 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4646 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4647 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4648 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4650 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4651 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4652 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4653 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4654 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4655 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4657 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4658 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4659 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4660 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4661 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4662 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4663 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4664 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4665 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4669 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4670 compatibility with Sendmail.
4672 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4673 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4674 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4675 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4676 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4677 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4678 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4679 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4684 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4685 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4686 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4687 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4688 set. Exim ignores this option.
4692 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4693 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4694 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4695 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4696 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4697 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4702 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4703 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4704 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4707 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4709 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4710 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4712 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4714 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4715 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4716 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4725 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4726 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4727 . creates a man page for the options.
4728 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4731 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4742 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4743 "The runtime configuration file"
4745 .cindex "run time configuration"
4746 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4747 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4748 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4749 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4750 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4751 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4752 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4753 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4756 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4757 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4758 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4759 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4760 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4761 actually alter the string.
4763 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4764 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4765 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4766 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4767 existing file in the list.
4770 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4771 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4772 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4773 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4774 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4775 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4776 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4777 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4778 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4779 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4781 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4782 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4783 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4784 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4785 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4787 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4788 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4789 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4790 compromise the Exim user account.
4792 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4793 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4794 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4795 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4796 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4797 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4802 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4803 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4804 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4805 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4806 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4807 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4808 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4809 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4810 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4811 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4812 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4814 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4815 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4816 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4817 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4818 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4819 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4820 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4821 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4822 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4825 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4826 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4827 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4828 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4829 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4831 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4832 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4833 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4834 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4835 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4836 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4838 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4839 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4840 necessarily be discarded.
4841 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4842 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4843 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4844 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4845 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4846 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4848 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4849 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4850 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4851 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4852 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4853 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4854 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4856 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4857 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4858 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4862 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4863 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4864 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4865 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4866 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4867 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4868 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4869 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4872 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4875 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4876 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4877 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4879 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4880 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4881 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4883 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4884 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4885 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4887 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4888 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4889 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4890 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4893 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4894 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4895 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4897 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4898 want to use this feature, you must set
4900 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4902 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4903 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4906 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4907 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4908 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4909 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4911 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4912 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4913 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4914 and does not introduce a comment.
4916 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4917 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4918 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4919 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4920 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4922 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4923 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4924 change settings as required.
4926 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4927 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4928 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4929 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4930 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4935 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4936 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4937 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4938 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4939 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4940 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4943 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4944 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4946 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4947 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4948 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4949 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4950 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4953 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4954 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4955 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4956 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4958 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4959 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4962 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4965 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4966 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4971 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4972 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4973 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4974 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4975 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4976 definition, and must be of the form
4978 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4980 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4981 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4982 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4983 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4984 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4986 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4987 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4988 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4990 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4991 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4992 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4993 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4994 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4995 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4996 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4999 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5000 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5002 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5003 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5004 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5005 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5006 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5007 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5010 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5011 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5012 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5017 MAC == updated value
5019 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5020 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5021 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5022 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5026 MAC == MAC and something added
5028 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5029 from a number of other files.
5031 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5032 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5033 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5034 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5035 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5040 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5041 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5042 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5043 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5045 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5046 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5048 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5050 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5052 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5053 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5054 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5057 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5058 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5059 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5060 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5061 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5064 The following classes of macros are defined:
5066 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5067 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5068 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5069 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5070 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5071 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5072 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5073 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5074 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5075 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5076 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5079 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5082 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5083 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5084 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5085 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5086 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5087 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5088 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5090 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5091 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5092 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5096 message_size_limit = 50M
5098 message_size_limit = 100M
5101 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5102 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5103 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5104 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5105 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5107 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5108 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5109 in this line"& will always be true.
5111 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5112 to clarify complicated nestings.
5116 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5117 .cindex "common option syntax"
5118 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5119 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5120 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5121 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5122 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5123 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5124 space) and then the value. For example:
5126 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5128 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5129 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5130 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5131 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5132 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5133 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5134 word &"hide"&. For example:
5136 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5138 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5140 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5142 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5143 all instances of the same driver.
5145 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5146 that are found in option settings.
5149 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5150 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5151 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5152 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5153 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5154 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5155 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5156 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5157 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5158 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5159 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5160 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5165 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5170 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5175 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5176 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5177 .cindex "format" "integer"
5178 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5179 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5180 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5181 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5184 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5185 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5186 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5188 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5189 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5190 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5194 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5195 .cindex "integer format"
5196 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5197 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5198 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5199 Such options are always output in octal.
5202 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5203 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5204 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5205 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5206 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5210 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5211 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5212 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5213 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5214 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5224 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5225 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5226 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5230 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5231 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5232 .cindex "format" "string"
5233 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5234 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5235 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5236 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5237 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5238 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5239 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5240 therefore equivalent:
5242 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5243 trusted_users = uucp:\
5244 # This comment line is ignored
5247 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5248 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5249 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5250 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5251 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5254 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5255 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5256 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5258 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5259 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5263 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5264 character, that character replaces the pair.
5266 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5267 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5268 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5269 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5270 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5271 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5274 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5275 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5276 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5277 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5278 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5279 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5280 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5281 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5282 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5283 within a quoted configuration string.
5286 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5287 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5288 .cindex "format" "user name"
5289 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5290 .cindex "format" "group name"
5291 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5292 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5293 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5294 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5297 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5298 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5299 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5300 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5301 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5302 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5303 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5304 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5305 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5306 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5307 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5309 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5310 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5311 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5312 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5313 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5314 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5317 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5319 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5321 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5322 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5323 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5324 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5326 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5327 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5328 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5329 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5330 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5331 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5332 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5333 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5335 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5337 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5338 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5339 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5341 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5342 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5343 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5344 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5345 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5346 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5347 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5348 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5349 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5351 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5353 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5354 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5355 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5356 the value in quotes. For example:
5358 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5360 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5361 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5362 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5363 enclosing an empty list item.
5367 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5368 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5369 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5370 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5372 senders = user@domain :
5374 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5375 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5376 items, the second of which is empty:
5378 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5380 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5381 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5382 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5383 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5387 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5388 is at the end of the list.
5393 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5394 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5395 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5396 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5397 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5398 a sequence of lines like this:
5400 <&'instance name'&>:
5405 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5406 followed by three options settings:
5411 transport = local_delivery
5413 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5414 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5415 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5416 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5417 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5418 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5420 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5421 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5423 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5424 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5425 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5426 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5427 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5430 .cindex "generic options"
5431 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5432 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5433 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5434 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5435 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5436 .cindex "private options"
5437 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5438 they all have default values.
5440 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5441 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5442 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5444 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5445 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5446 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5447 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5448 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5449 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5450 configuration lines:
5455 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5456 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5457 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5458 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5464 command_timeout = 10s
5466 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5467 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5470 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5471 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5472 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5483 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5484 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5485 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5486 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5487 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5488 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5489 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5490 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5491 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5492 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5493 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5497 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5498 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5499 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5502 # primary_hostname =
5504 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5505 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5506 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5507 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5509 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5511 domainlist local_domains = @
5512 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5513 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5515 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5516 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5517 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5518 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5520 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5521 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5524 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5525 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5526 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5527 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5528 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5529 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5531 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5532 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5533 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5534 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5535 domain is permitted.
5537 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5538 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5539 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5540 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5541 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5542 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5544 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5545 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5546 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5548 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5550 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5551 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5553 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5554 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5555 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5556 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5557 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5558 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5559 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5560 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5561 contents of a message to be checked.
5563 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5565 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5566 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5568 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5569 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5570 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5571 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5573 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5575 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5576 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5577 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5579 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5580 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5581 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5582 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5583 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5584 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5585 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5587 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5589 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5590 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5592 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5593 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5594 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5595 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5596 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5597 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5598 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5599 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5600 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5601 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5602 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5603 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5604 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5605 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5606 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5607 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5609 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5610 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5611 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5612 which should be used in preference to 587.
5613 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5615 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5617 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5620 # qualify_recipient =
5622 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5623 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5624 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5625 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5626 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5627 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5629 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5630 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5631 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5632 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5634 # allow_domain_literals
5636 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5637 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5638 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5639 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5640 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5641 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5643 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5647 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5648 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5649 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5650 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5651 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5652 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5653 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5654 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5656 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5657 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5662 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5663 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5664 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5665 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5666 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5667 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5670 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5671 1413 (hence their names):
5674 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5676 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5677 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5678 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5679 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5680 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5681 information, you can change this.
5683 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5684 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5689 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5690 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5691 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5692 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5694 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5695 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5697 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5698 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5700 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5703 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5704 +tls_certificate_verified
5707 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5709 # percent_hack_domains =
5711 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5712 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5713 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5715 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5716 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5717 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5718 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5719 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5720 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5721 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5722 always bounce messages.
5724 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5725 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5727 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5728 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5729 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5730 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5731 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5733 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5734 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5735 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5736 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5737 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5740 # split_spool_directory = true
5743 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5744 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5745 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5746 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5747 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5748 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5749 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5751 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5754 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5755 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5756 that are not 8-bit clean.
5758 # accept_8bitmime = false
5761 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5762 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5763 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5764 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5765 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5766 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5768 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5769 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5773 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5774 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5775 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5776 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5777 It starts with the line
5781 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5782 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5783 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5785 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5786 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5787 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5788 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5789 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5790 result of the ACL processing.
5794 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5799 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5800 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5801 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5802 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5803 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5804 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5806 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5807 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5808 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5811 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5812 domains = +local_domains
5813 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5815 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5816 domains = !+local_domains
5817 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5819 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5820 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5821 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5822 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5823 in Internet mail addresses.
5825 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5826 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5827 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5828 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5829 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5830 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5831 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5832 policy of being as safe as possible.
5834 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5835 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5836 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5837 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5838 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5839 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5841 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5842 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5843 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5844 have to modify this rule.
5846 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5847 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5848 common convention of local parts constructed as
5849 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5850 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5851 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5852 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5853 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5854 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5856 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5857 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5858 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5859 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5860 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5861 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5862 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5864 accept local_parts = postmaster
5865 domains = +local_domains
5867 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5868 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5869 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5870 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5871 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5873 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5874 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5875 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5877 require verify = sender
5879 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5880 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5881 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5882 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5883 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5884 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5885 discusses the details of address verification.
5887 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5888 control = submission
5890 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5891 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5892 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5893 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5894 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5895 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5896 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5897 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5898 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5900 accept authenticated = *
5901 control = submission
5903 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5904 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5905 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5906 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5907 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5908 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5910 require message = relay not permitted
5911 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5913 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5914 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5916 require verify = recipient
5918 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5919 fails, the address is rejected.
5921 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5922 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5924 # dnslists = black.list.example
5926 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5927 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5928 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5929 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5931 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5932 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5933 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5936 # require verify = csa
5938 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5939 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5944 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5945 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5949 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5950 of this ACL are commented out:
5953 # message = This message contains a virus \
5956 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5957 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5958 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5959 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5961 # warn spam = nobody
5962 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5963 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5964 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5965 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5967 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5968 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5969 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5970 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5971 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5972 whatever the spam score.
5976 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5979 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5980 .cindex "default" "routers"
5981 .cindex "routers" "default"
5982 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5987 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5988 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5989 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5990 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5991 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5994 # driver = ipliteral
5995 # domains = !+local_domains
5996 # transport = remote_smtp
5998 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5999 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6000 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6001 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6002 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6006 domains = ! +local_domains
6007 transport = remote_smtp
6008 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6011 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6012 domains. This is specified by the line
6014 domains = ! +local_domains
6016 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6017 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6018 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6019 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6020 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6021 passed on to the following routers.
6023 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6024 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6025 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6026 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6027 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6029 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6030 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6031 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6032 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6033 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6034 the address fails and is bounced.
6036 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6037 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6038 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6039 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6040 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6041 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6042 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6049 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6051 file_transport = address_file
6052 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6054 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6055 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6056 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6057 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6058 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6061 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6062 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6063 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6064 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6069 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6070 # local_part_suffix_optional
6071 file = $home/.forward
6076 file_transport = address_file
6077 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6078 reply_transport = address_reply
6080 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6081 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6082 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6083 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6084 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6087 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6088 # local_part_suffix_optional
6090 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6091 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6092 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6093 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6094 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6095 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6096 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6098 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6099 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6100 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6101 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6103 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6104 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6105 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6106 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6107 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6108 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6109 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6111 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6112 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6113 There are two reasons for doing this:
6116 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6117 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6120 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6121 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6122 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6123 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6127 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6128 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6129 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6130 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6132 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6133 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6134 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6136 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6138 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6144 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6145 # local_part_suffix_optional
6146 transport = local_delivery
6148 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6149 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6150 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6151 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6152 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6155 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6156 .cindex "default" "transports"
6157 .cindex "transports" "default"
6158 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6159 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6160 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6164 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6170 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6171 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6172 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6173 It is negotiated between client and server
6174 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6175 All other options are defaulted.
6179 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6186 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6187 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6188 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6189 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6190 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6191 show how this can be done.
6193 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6194 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6195 similarly-named options above.
6201 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6202 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6203 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6204 be returned to the sender.
6212 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6213 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6214 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6219 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6224 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6225 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6226 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6227 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6228 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6229 introduced by the line
6233 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6236 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6238 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6239 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6240 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6241 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6242 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6244 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6245 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6246 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6249 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6250 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6254 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6255 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6259 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6260 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6261 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6263 begin authenticators
6265 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6266 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6267 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6268 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6269 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6270 to support most MUA software.
6272 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6275 # driver = plaintext
6276 # server_set_id = $auth2
6277 # server_prompts = :
6278 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6279 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6281 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6284 # driver = plaintext
6285 # server_set_id = $auth1
6286 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6287 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6288 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6291 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6292 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6293 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6294 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6295 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6296 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6297 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6298 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6300 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6301 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6302 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6303 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6305 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6306 usercode and password are in different positions.
6307 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6309 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6316 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6318 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6320 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6321 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6322 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6323 regular expressions is discussed in
6324 online Perl manpages, in
6325 many Perl reference books, and also in
6326 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6327 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6329 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6330 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6331 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6332 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6333 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6336 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6337 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6338 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6339 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6341 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6343 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6344 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6345 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6346 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6347 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6348 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6351 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6352 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6353 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6354 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6355 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6356 match anywhere in the subject string.
6358 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6359 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6361 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6363 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6366 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6368 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6369 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6373 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6374 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6376 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6377 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6378 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6379 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6380 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6381 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6384 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6385 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6386 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6387 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6388 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6389 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6391 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6392 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6393 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6394 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6395 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6396 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6399 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6400 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6401 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6402 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6403 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6404 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6406 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6407 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6408 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6409 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6410 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6412 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6413 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6415 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6416 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6417 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6418 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6419 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6421 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6422 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6424 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6425 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6427 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6428 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6429 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6434 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6435 matches the list item.
6437 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6438 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6440 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6442 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6443 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6444 causes a second lookup to occur.
6446 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6447 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6448 lookup is permitted.
6451 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6452 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6453 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6454 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6457 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6458 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6459 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6461 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6462 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6463 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6464 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6467 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6468 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6469 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6474 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6475 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6476 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6481 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6482 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6483 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6484 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6487 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6488 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6489 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6490 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6491 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6492 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6493 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6494 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6495 be found in several places:
6497 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6498 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6499 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6501 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6502 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6503 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6504 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6506 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6507 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6508 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6509 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6510 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6511 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6512 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6514 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6515 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6516 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6517 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6518 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6519 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6520 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6522 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6523 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6525 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6526 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6527 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6528 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6529 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6530 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6531 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6533 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6534 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6535 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6537 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6538 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6539 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6540 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6541 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6542 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6543 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6544 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6545 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6546 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6548 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6549 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6550 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6551 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6552 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6553 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6554 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6555 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6556 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6558 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6559 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6560 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6561 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6562 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6563 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6564 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6566 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6567 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6568 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6569 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6571 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6572 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6573 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6574 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6575 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6577 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6578 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6579 lookup types support only literal keys.
6581 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6582 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6583 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6585 .cindex "linear search"
6586 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6587 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6588 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6589 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6590 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6591 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6592 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6593 in the file is used.
6595 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6596 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6597 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6598 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6599 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6604 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6605 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6606 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6607 wildcarding of any kind.
6609 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6610 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6611 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6612 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6613 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6614 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6615 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6616 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6617 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6620 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6621 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6622 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6623 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6624 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6625 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6626 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6627 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6630 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6631 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6632 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6633 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6634 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6635 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6636 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6637 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6638 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6640 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6641 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6642 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6643 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6645 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6646 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6649 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6651 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6652 *fish data for anythingfish
6655 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6656 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6658 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6660 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6661 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6662 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6664 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6666 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6667 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6668 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6670 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6673 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6674 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6675 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6676 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6677 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6679 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6680 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6681 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6682 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6683 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6686 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6687 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6688 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6691 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6693 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6696 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6697 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6698 be followed by optional colons.
6700 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6701 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6702 lookup types support only literal keys.
6706 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6707 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6708 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6709 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6710 many of them are given in later sections.
6713 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6714 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6715 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6716 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6717 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6719 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6720 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6721 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6723 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6724 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6725 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6726 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6727 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6728 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6729 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6731 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6732 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6733 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6734 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6736 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6737 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6738 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6739 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6741 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6742 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6743 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6744 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6746 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6747 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6748 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6749 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6750 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6751 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6752 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6753 password value. For example:
6755 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6758 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6759 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6760 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6761 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6764 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6765 .cindex lookup Redis
6766 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6767 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6770 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6772 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6773 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6776 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6777 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6779 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6780 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6781 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6782 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6783 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6784 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6785 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6786 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6787 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6789 require condition = \
6790 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6792 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6793 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6794 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6795 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6800 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6801 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6802 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6803 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6804 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6805 options such as a list of local domains.
6807 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6808 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6809 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6810 or may give up altogether.
6814 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6815 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6816 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6817 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6818 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6819 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6820 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6821 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6823 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6824 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6825 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6827 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6828 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6829 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6831 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6832 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6833 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6834 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6835 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6836 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6837 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6838 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6839 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6840 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6842 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6844 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6845 looks up these keys, in this order:
6851 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6852 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6853 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6854 Exim move on to try the next key.
6858 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6859 .cindex "partial matching"
6860 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6861 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6862 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6863 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6864 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6865 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6866 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6867 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6868 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6869 a key in a DBM file is
6871 *.dates.fict.example
6873 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6874 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6875 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6878 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6879 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6880 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6882 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6883 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6884 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6885 partial matching keys
6886 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6887 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6888 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6890 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6891 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6892 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6893 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6894 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6895 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6898 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6899 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6900 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6901 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6902 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6903 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6905 2250.dates.fict.example
6906 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6907 *.dates.fict.example
6910 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6913 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6914 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6915 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6916 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6917 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6918 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6920 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6922 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6923 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6924 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6925 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6927 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6929 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6930 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6932 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6933 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6934 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6937 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6939 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6940 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6942 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6943 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6944 for &"*"& on its own.
6946 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6950 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6951 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6952 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6953 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6954 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6955 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6956 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6958 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6959 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6960 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6961 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6962 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6967 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6968 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6969 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6970 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6971 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6972 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6973 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6975 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6976 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6977 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6978 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6979 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6980 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6982 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6983 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6989 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6990 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6991 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6992 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6993 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6994 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6998 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6999 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7001 [name="$local_part"]
7003 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7004 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7005 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7006 of the following form is provided:
7008 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7010 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7012 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7014 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7015 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7016 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7021 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7022 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7023 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7024 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7025 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7026 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7027 an expansion string could contain:
7029 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7031 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7032 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7033 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7034 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7036 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7037 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7038 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7040 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7041 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7042 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7043 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7044 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7046 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7048 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7049 white space is ignored.
7050 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7051 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7052 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7054 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7055 When the type is PTR,
7056 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7057 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7059 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7061 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7062 altered and nothing is added.
7064 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7065 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7066 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7067 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7068 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7069 The field separator can be modified as above.
7071 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7072 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7073 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7074 unless a field separator is specified.
7075 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7077 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7079 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7080 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7081 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7083 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7084 white space is ignored.
7086 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7087 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7088 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7089 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7092 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7095 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7096 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7097 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7098 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7099 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7100 each followed by a comma,
7101 that may appear before the record type.
7103 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7104 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7105 a defer-option modifier.
7106 The possible keywords are
7107 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7108 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7109 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7110 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7111 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7112 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7113 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7115 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7116 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7118 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7119 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7121 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7122 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7123 The possible keywords are
7124 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7125 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7127 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7128 is not labelled as authenticated data
7129 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7130 The default is &"never"&.
7132 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7134 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7135 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7136 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7137 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7139 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7141 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7142 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7143 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7145 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7146 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7148 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7149 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7150 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7153 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7154 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7155 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7156 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7157 the pseudo-type MXH:
7159 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7161 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7164 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7165 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7166 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7167 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7168 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7169 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7170 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7171 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7173 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7174 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7176 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7177 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7178 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7180 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7181 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7182 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7183 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7184 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7187 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7188 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7189 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7190 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7191 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7192 result of a successful lookup such as:
7194 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7196 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7197 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7198 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7200 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7201 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7202 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7203 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7205 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7209 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7210 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7211 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7212 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7213 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7215 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7216 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7217 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7219 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7220 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7221 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7222 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7224 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7225 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7226 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7231 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7232 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7233 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7234 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7235 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7236 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7237 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7238 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7239 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7240 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7241 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7242 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7244 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7245 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7246 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7247 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7248 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7250 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7251 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7253 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7254 the way they handle the results of a query:
7257 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7260 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7261 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7263 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7264 from all of them are returned.
7268 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7269 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7270 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7271 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7274 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7275 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7276 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7277 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7279 data = ${lookup ldap \
7280 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7281 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7283 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7284 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7285 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7286 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7288 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7289 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7290 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7292 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7293 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7294 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7295 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7296 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7297 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7298 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7299 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7303 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7304 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7305 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7306 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7307 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7308 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7310 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7311 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7319 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7320 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7324 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7326 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7330 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7332 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7334 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7336 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7337 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7338 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7342 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7343 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7344 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7346 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7350 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7352 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7354 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7356 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7357 authentication below.
7360 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7361 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7362 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7363 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7364 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7367 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7369 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7370 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7371 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7372 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7373 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7374 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7375 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7376 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7377 failures, and timeouts.
7379 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7380 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7381 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7382 doubled. For example
7384 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7386 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7387 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7388 the local host) is used.
7390 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7391 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7392 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7393 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7396 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7397 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7398 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7399 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7401 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7403 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7404 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7406 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7408 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7409 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7410 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7411 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7412 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7413 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7414 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7417 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7418 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7419 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7422 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7425 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7429 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7430 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7434 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7435 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7436 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7437 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7438 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7439 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7440 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7441 them. The following names are recognized:
7443 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7444 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7445 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7446 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7447 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7448 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7449 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7450 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7452 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7453 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7454 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7455 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7457 .cindex LDAP timeout
7458 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7459 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7460 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7461 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7462 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7463 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7464 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7465 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7466 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7467 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7469 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7470 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7472 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7473 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7474 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7475 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7476 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7477 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7478 alternate list (colon-separated).
7480 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7481 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7484 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7485 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7488 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7489 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7490 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7491 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7493 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7494 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7495 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7497 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7498 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7499 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7500 quoting has two advantages:
7503 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7504 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7506 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7509 For example, a setting such as
7511 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7513 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7515 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7516 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7517 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7518 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7522 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7523 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7528 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7529 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7530 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7531 as a sequence of values, for example
7533 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7535 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7536 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7537 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7538 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7539 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7542 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7543 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7544 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7545 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7547 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7548 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7549 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7550 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7551 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7552 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7553 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7554 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7555 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7557 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7558 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7559 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7560 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7561 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7564 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7567 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7570 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7571 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7573 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7574 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7576 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7577 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7580 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7581 results of LDAP lookups.
7582 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7583 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7584 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7585 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7586 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7587 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7592 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7593 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7594 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7595 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7596 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7597 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7598 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7599 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7601 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7603 might return the string
7605 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7606 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7608 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7610 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7616 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7617 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7618 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7622 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7623 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7624 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7625 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7626 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7627 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7628 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7629 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7630 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7631 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7632 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7633 .cindex lookup Redis
7634 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7636 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7639 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7642 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7643 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7645 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7650 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7652 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7653 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7654 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7658 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7659 with a newline between the data for each row.
7662 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7663 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7664 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7665 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7666 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7667 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7668 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7669 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7670 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7671 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7672 .cindex lookup Redis
7673 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7674 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7675 or &%redis_servers%&
7676 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7678 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7679 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7680 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7682 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7683 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7684 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7685 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7687 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7689 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7690 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7691 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7693 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7694 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7696 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7697 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7698 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7699 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7700 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7701 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7703 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7704 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7705 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7707 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7708 host, database number, and password.
7710 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7711 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7712 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7714 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7716 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7719 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7720 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7721 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7722 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7724 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7725 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7727 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7728 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7729 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7730 done by starting the query with
7732 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7734 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7736 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7737 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7738 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7741 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7743 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7744 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7745 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7747 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7748 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7749 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7752 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7756 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7758 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7760 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7761 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7762 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7764 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7768 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7769 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7770 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7771 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7772 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7773 the default value is &"exim"&.
7774 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7776 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7777 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7779 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7780 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7782 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7785 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7786 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7788 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7789 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7790 is zero because no rows are affected.
7793 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7794 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7795 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7796 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7797 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7800 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7802 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7803 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7804 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7806 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7807 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7810 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7811 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7812 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7813 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7814 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7815 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7816 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7817 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7818 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7820 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7821 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7823 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7825 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7826 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7828 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7829 quote, which it doubles.
7831 .cindex timeout SQLite
7832 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7833 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7834 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7835 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7836 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7837 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7838 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7841 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7842 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7843 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7844 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7847 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7848 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7851 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
7852 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
7853 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
7854 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
7857 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
7858 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
7859 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
7866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7869 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7870 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7871 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7872 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7873 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7874 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7875 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7876 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7877 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7879 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7880 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7881 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7882 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7884 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7885 support all the complexity available in
7886 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7890 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7891 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7892 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7894 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7895 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7898 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7899 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7900 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7901 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7902 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7905 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7906 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7907 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7909 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7910 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7911 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7912 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7913 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7915 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7916 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7918 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7919 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7920 senders based on the receiving domain.
7925 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7926 .cindex "list" "negation"
7927 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7928 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7929 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7930 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7931 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7932 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7934 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7935 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7936 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7937 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7938 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7940 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7942 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7943 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7944 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7946 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7948 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7949 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7950 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7952 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7953 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7958 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7959 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7960 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7961 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7962 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7963 file names are not allowed,
7964 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7965 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7969 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7970 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7972 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7973 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7974 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7976 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7980 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7981 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7982 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7983 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7985 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7986 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7988 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7990 and the file contains the lines
7995 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7996 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8000 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8001 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8002 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8003 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8004 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8005 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8006 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8007 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8009 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8010 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
8011 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8012 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8017 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8018 .cindex "named lists"
8019 .cindex "list" "named"
8020 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8021 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8022 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8023 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8024 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8025 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8026 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8028 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8030 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8031 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8032 configured with the line
8034 domains = +local_domains
8036 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8037 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8041 domains = ! +local_domains
8042 transport = remote_smtp
8045 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8046 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8047 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8048 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8050 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8051 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8053 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8055 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8056 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8057 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8059 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8060 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8061 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8063 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8064 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8066 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8067 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8068 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8070 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8072 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8073 referenced lists if you can.
8075 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8076 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8077 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8079 domains = +local_domains
8081 on several of your routers
8082 or in several ACL statements,
8083 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8084 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8085 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8086 the same each time they are referenced.
8088 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8089 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8090 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8091 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8095 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8096 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8097 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8098 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8099 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8102 ALIST = host1 : host2
8103 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8105 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8107 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8109 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8112 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8113 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8115 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8117 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8121 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8122 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8123 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8124 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8125 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8126 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8127 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8128 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8129 message. For example:
8131 domainlist special_domains = \
8132 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8134 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8135 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8136 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8137 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8138 same list each time.
8140 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8141 cache the result anyway. For example:
8143 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8145 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8146 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8150 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8151 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8152 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8153 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8154 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8157 .cindex "primary host name"
8158 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8159 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8160 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8161 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8162 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8163 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8164 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8165 differ only in their names.
8167 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8168 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8169 .cindex "domain literal"
8170 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8171 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8172 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8173 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8174 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8175 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8178 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8179 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8180 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8181 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8182 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8183 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8184 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8185 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8186 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8187 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8188 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8190 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8191 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8192 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8193 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8194 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8196 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8197 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8198 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8199 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8200 on a router). For example:
8202 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8204 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8205 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8207 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8208 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8209 contain negative items.
8211 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8212 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8213 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8215 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8216 an.other.domain : ...
8218 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8219 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8221 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8222 an.other.domain ? ...
8225 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8226 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8227 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8228 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8229 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8230 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8231 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8232 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8233 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8237 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8238 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8239 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8240 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8241 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8242 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8243 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8244 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8245 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8247 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8248 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8249 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8250 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8251 expression by expansion, of course).
8253 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8254 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8255 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8256 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8257 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8258 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8260 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8262 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8263 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8264 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8265 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8266 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8267 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8268 other statements in the same ACL.
8271 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8272 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8274 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8276 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8277 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8280 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8281 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8282 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8283 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8284 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8285 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8288 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8289 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8290 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8291 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8293 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8294 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8296 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8297 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8298 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8299 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8300 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8302 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8303 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8304 between the pattern and the domain.
8307 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8309 domainlist funny_domains = \
8312 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8313 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8314 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8315 nis;domains.byname : \
8316 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8318 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8319 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8320 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8321 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8322 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8327 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8328 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8329 .cindex "list" "host list"
8330 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8331 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8332 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8333 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8334 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8335 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8336 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8339 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8340 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8341 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8342 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8343 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8344 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8347 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8348 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8349 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8353 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8354 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8355 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8356 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8357 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8358 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8359 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8362 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8363 inspecting its IP address:
8366 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8367 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8368 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8369 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8370 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8371 with the IP address of the subject host.
8373 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8374 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8375 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8376 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8377 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8380 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8381 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8382 domain name, as just described.
8385 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8386 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8387 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8388 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8389 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8390 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8391 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8392 that can never match a client host.
8395 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8396 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8397 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8398 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8400 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8404 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8405 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8406 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8407 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8408 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8409 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8410 significant end of the address.
8412 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8413 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8414 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8415 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8419 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8420 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8423 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8425 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8426 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8428 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8429 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8432 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8434 could make use of a file containing
8439 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8440 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8441 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8443 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8446 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8452 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8453 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8454 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8455 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8456 address, the pattern takes this form:
8458 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8462 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8464 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8465 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8466 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8467 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8468 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8469 returned by the lookup is not used.
8471 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8472 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8473 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8474 patterns of this form:
8476 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8480 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8482 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8483 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8484 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8485 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8486 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8488 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8489 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8490 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8491 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8492 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8493 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8494 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8495 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8496 addresses are always used.
8498 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8499 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8500 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8503 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8504 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8505 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8506 case the IP address is used on its own.
8510 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8511 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8512 .cindex "unknown host name"
8513 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8514 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8515 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8516 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8517 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8520 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8521 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8522 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8523 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8524 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8525 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8526 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8528 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8529 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8531 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8532 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8533 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8534 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8535 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8536 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8537 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8538 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8539 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8541 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8542 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8544 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8545 .cindex "alias for host"
8546 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8547 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8550 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8551 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8552 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8553 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8554 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8557 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8558 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8559 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8560 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8561 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8562 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8563 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8568 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8569 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8570 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8571 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8572 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8574 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8576 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8577 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8578 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8585 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8586 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8587 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8588 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8589 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8590 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8592 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8593 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8595 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8596 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8597 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8598 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8599 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8600 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8601 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8602 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8603 not recognized in an indirected file).
8606 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8607 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8609 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8611 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8612 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8615 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8616 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8619 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8622 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8623 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8624 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8627 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8628 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8631 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8633 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8635 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8636 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8637 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8640 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8641 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8642 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8644 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8646 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8647 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8648 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8649 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8650 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8651 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8652 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8655 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8656 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8658 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8659 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8661 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8662 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8663 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8668 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8670 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8671 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8672 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8673 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8674 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8675 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8676 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8677 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8678 host lists such as whitelists.
8682 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8683 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8684 .cindex "unknown host name"
8685 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8686 If a pattern is of the form
8688 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8692 dbm;/host/accept/list
8694 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8695 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8698 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8699 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8700 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8701 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8702 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8703 lookup, both using the same file.
8707 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8708 If a pattern is of the form
8710 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8712 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8713 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8714 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8716 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8717 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8719 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8720 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8721 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8724 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8725 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8726 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8728 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8729 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8730 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8731 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8732 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8733 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8739 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8740 .cindex "list" "address list"
8741 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8742 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8743 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8744 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8745 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8746 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8747 using this option setting:
8751 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8752 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8753 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8754 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8756 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8759 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8761 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8762 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8763 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8764 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8765 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8766 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8767 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8769 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8770 *@+hostile_domains:\
8771 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8772 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8774 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8775 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8776 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8777 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8778 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8780 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8781 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8782 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8783 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8784 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8786 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8789 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8790 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8794 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8795 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8796 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8797 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8798 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8799 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8800 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8802 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8803 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8805 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8806 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8809 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8810 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8811 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8814 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8815 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8816 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8818 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8819 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8820 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8821 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8823 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8824 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8826 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8827 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8828 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8829 default. For example, with this lookup:
8831 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8833 the file could contains lines like this:
8835 user1@domain1.example
8838 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8841 nimrod@jaeger.example
8845 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8846 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8848 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8850 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8851 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8853 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8854 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8855 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8859 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8860 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8865 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8866 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8867 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8868 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8869 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8870 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8871 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8872 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8873 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8875 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8876 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8877 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8878 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8879 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8882 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8884 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8886 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8888 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8890 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8891 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8892 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8893 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8894 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8895 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8897 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8900 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8903 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8904 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8905 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8906 might have entries like
8908 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8909 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8912 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8913 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8914 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8915 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8917 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8918 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8919 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8922 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8923 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8924 can only return a single list of local parts.
8927 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8928 in these two examples:
8931 senders = *@+my_list
8933 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8934 example it is a named domain list.
8939 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8940 .cindex "case of local parts"
8941 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8942 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8943 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8944 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8945 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8946 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8947 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8948 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8951 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8952 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8953 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8954 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8955 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8956 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8957 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8960 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8961 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8962 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8963 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8964 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8965 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8966 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8967 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8971 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8972 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8973 .cindex "local part" "list"
8974 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8975 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8976 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8977 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8978 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8979 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8980 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8981 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8983 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8984 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8985 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8986 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8987 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8988 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8989 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8991 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8996 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8997 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8999 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9000 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9001 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9002 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9004 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9005 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9006 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9007 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9008 escape character, as described in the following section.
9010 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9011 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9012 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9013 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9014 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9019 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9020 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9021 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9022 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9023 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9024 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9025 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9026 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9028 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9029 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9030 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9031 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9033 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9035 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9036 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9041 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9042 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9043 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9044 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9045 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9046 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9047 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9050 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9051 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9052 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9055 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9056 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9057 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9059 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9060 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9061 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9062 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9063 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9064 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9065 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9068 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9069 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9070 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9073 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9074 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9075 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9076 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9078 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9080 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9081 Exim message identifier. For example:
9083 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9085 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9086 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9089 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9090 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9091 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9092 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9093 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9094 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9095 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9096 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9097 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9098 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9099 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9100 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9106 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9107 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9108 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9109 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9110 white space is significant.
9113 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9114 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9115 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9120 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9121 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9122 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9123 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9124 given, the expansion fails.
9126 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9127 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9128 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9129 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9133 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9134 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9135 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9136 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9137 string easier to understand.
9139 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9140 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9141 expansion item below.
9144 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9145 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9146 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9147 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9148 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9149 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9150 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9151 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9152 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9153 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9154 the result of the expansion.
9155 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9156 the expansion result is an empty string.
9157 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9160 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9161 .cindex authentication "results header"
9162 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9163 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9164 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9165 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9167 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9168 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9169 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9178 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9180 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9182 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9185 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9186 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9187 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9188 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9189 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9190 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9191 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9192 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9196 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9197 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9202 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9206 If the field is found,
9207 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9208 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9209 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9210 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9212 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9213 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9216 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9218 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9219 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9221 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9222 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9223 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9224 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9225 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9226 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9227 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9228 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9230 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9231 take an optional modifier of "int"
9232 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9233 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9234 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9236 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9237 newline-separated by default,
9238 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9239 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9240 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9242 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9243 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9244 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9245 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9246 if so the element tags are omitted.
9248 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9250 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9251 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9253 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9254 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9258 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9259 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9260 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9262 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9263 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9264 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9265 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9266 must have the following type:
9268 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9270 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9271 function should return one of the following values:
9273 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9274 into the expanded string that is being built.
9276 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9277 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9279 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9280 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9282 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9284 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9285 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9286 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9289 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9290 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9291 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9292 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9294 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9295 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9296 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9298 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9299 appear, for example:
9301 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9303 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9304 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9306 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9308 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9311 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9312 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9315 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9316 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9317 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9318 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9319 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9320 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9321 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9322 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9324 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9327 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9328 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9329 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9330 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9331 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9332 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9333 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9334 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9335 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9337 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9338 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9339 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9342 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9343 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9345 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9346 appear, for example:
9348 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9350 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9351 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9354 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9355 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9356 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9357 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9358 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9359 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9360 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9361 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9362 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9363 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9364 <&'string3'&> as before.
9366 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9367 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9368 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9369 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9370 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9371 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9372 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9373 provided. For example:
9375 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9379 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9381 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9382 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9385 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9386 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9387 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9389 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9390 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9391 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9392 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9393 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9394 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9395 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9397 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9399 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9400 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9403 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9404 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9405 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9406 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9407 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9408 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9410 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9411 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9412 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9413 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9415 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9417 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9418 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9419 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9420 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9421 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9423 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9425 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9426 letters appear. For example:
9428 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9429 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9430 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9433 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9434 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9435 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9436 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9437 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9438 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9439 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9440 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9441 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9442 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9443 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9444 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9445 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9446 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9447 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9448 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9449 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9453 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9454 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9455 lines) may be present.
9457 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9458 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9461 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9462 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9463 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9466 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9467 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9468 are multiple headers with a given name.
9469 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9470 list-processing facilities can be used.
9471 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9472 the content is &"raw"&.
9475 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9476 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9477 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9478 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9479 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9480 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9481 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9482 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9485 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9486 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9487 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9488 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9489 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9490 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9493 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9494 command of the following form:
9496 headers charset "UTF-8"
9498 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9499 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9500 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9501 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9502 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9505 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9506 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9507 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9508 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9510 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9511 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9512 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9513 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9514 router or transport are not accessible.
9516 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9517 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9518 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9519 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9520 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9521 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9522 point they are added.
9523 When any of the above ACLs ar
9524 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9526 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9527 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9528 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9529 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9530 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9531 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9532 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9535 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9536 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9537 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9538 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9539 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9540 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9541 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9542 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9545 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9546 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9548 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9549 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9550 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9551 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9552 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9553 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9554 present. For example:
9556 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9558 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9561 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9563 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9564 an Exim configuration:
9566 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9568 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9571 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9572 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9573 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9575 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9576 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9577 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9578 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9579 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9580 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9583 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9584 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9585 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9586 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9587 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9588 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9590 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9592 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9593 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9594 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9595 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9596 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9598 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9599 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9600 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9602 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9606 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9611 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9612 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9613 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9614 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9615 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9616 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9620 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9621 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9622 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9623 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9624 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9625 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9626 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9629 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9631 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9632 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9633 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9636 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9637 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9638 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9639 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9640 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9641 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9642 apart from an optional leading minus,
9643 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9645 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9646 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9648 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9649 If the number is negative, the fields are
9650 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9651 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9652 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9654 If the modulus of the
9655 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9656 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9660 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9664 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9666 yields &"result: 42"&.
9668 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9669 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9671 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9674 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9675 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9676 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9677 described in the next item.
9679 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9680 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9681 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9682 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9683 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9684 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9685 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9686 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9687 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9689 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9690 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9691 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9692 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9693 out by the system administrator.
9696 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9697 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9698 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9699 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9700 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9701 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9702 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9703 original lookup fails.
9705 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9706 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9707 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9708 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9709 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9710 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9711 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9712 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9714 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9715 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9716 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9717 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9719 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9720 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9721 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9722 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9724 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9726 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9728 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9729 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9731 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9736 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9737 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9739 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9740 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9741 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9742 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9743 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9744 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9746 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9748 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9749 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9750 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9752 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9753 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9754 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9755 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9756 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9757 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9758 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9760 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9762 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9763 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9764 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9765 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9768 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9770 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9774 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9775 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9776 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9777 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9778 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9779 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9780 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9781 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9783 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9784 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9785 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9786 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9787 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9790 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9791 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9792 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9794 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9795 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9798 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9799 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9800 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9801 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9802 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9803 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9804 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9805 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9807 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9808 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9809 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9810 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9811 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9812 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9813 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9814 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9815 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9816 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9818 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9819 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9820 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9821 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9823 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9824 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9825 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9826 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9827 is the expansion of the third argument.
9829 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9830 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9831 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9833 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9834 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9835 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9836 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9837 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9838 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9839 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9840 newlines are left in the string.
9841 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9842 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9843 the string expansion fails.
9845 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9846 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9850 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9851 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9852 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9853 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9854 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9855 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9856 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9859 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9860 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9862 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9863 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9864 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9865 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9866 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9869 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9871 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9872 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9873 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9874 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9875 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9876 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9877 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9879 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9881 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9882 and must be present if the argument is given.
9883 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9884 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9885 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9886 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9888 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9890 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9891 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9892 turns them into spaces:
9894 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9896 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9897 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9898 addition, the following errors can occur:
9901 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9903 Failure to connect the socket;
9905 Failure to write the request string;
9907 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9910 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9911 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9912 errors occurs. For example:
9914 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9917 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9918 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9919 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9920 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9921 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9923 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9924 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9927 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9928 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9929 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9932 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9933 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9934 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9935 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9936 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9937 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9938 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9939 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9940 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9942 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9944 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9947 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9949 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9950 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9953 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9954 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9955 expansion item above.
9957 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9958 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9959 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9960 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9961 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9962 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9963 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9964 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9965 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9967 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9968 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9969 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9970 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9971 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9972 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9973 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9974 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9975 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9978 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9979 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9980 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9982 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9983 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9984 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9985 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9986 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9989 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9990 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9991 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9992 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9994 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9995 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9996 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9999 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10000 log_message = Output of id: $value
10002 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10003 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10005 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10008 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10009 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10010 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10012 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10013 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10017 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10018 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10021 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10022 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10023 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10024 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10026 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10027 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10030 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10031 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10032 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10033 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10034 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10035 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10036 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10037 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10039 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10041 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10042 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10043 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10045 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10047 yields &"defabc"&, and
10049 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10051 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10052 the regular expression from string expansion.
10056 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10057 .cindex sorting "a list"
10058 .cindex list sorting
10059 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10060 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10061 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10062 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10063 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10064 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10065 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10066 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10067 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10068 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10069 to give values for comparison.
10071 The item result is a sorted list,
10072 with the original list separator,
10073 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10077 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10079 sorts a list of numbers, and
10081 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10083 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10086 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10087 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10088 .cindex "substring extraction"
10089 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10090 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10091 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10092 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10093 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10095 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10097 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10098 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10101 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10102 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10103 length required. For example
10105 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10107 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10108 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10109 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10110 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10112 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10113 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10114 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10116 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10118 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10119 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10120 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10122 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10124 yields an empty string, but
10126 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10130 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10131 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10132 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10133 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10136 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10138 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10142 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10143 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10144 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10145 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10146 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10147 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10148 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10149 replacement list. For example
10151 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10153 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10154 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10155 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10161 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10162 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10163 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10164 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10165 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10166 following operations can be performed:
10169 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10170 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10171 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10172 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10173 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10174 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10177 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10178 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10179 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10180 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10181 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10182 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10183 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10184 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10185 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10187 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10188 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10189 character. For example:
10191 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10193 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10194 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10195 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10196 separator explicitly:
10198 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10201 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10202 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10203 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10206 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10207 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10208 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10209 email address separator. For the example header line:
10211 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10213 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10214 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10215 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10216 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10217 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10218 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10221 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10222 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10224 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10225 Last:user@example.com
10226 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10230 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10231 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10232 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10233 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10234 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10235 Only lowercase letters are used.
10237 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10238 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10239 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10240 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10241 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10243 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10244 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10245 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10246 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10247 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10248 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10249 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10250 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10251 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10253 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10254 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10255 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10256 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10257 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10258 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10261 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10262 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10263 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10264 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10265 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10266 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10268 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10269 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10272 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10273 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10274 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10275 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10276 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10279 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10280 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10281 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10282 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10283 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10286 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10287 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10288 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10289 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10290 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10291 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10292 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10294 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10295 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10296 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10297 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10298 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10299 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10302 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10303 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10304 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10305 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10306 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10307 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10308 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10309 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10310 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10311 C programming language):
10313 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10314 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10315 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10316 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10317 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10319 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10321 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10322 space is permitted before or after operators.
10324 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10325 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10326 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10327 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10328 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10330 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10332 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10333 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10336 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10337 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10338 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10339 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10340 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10341 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10342 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10343 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10344 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10345 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10346 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10349 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10351 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10354 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10357 {$recipients_count} \
10358 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10362 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10363 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10366 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10367 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10368 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10371 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10373 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10374 and then re-expands what it has found.
10377 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10379 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10380 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10381 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10382 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10383 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10384 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10385 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10386 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10387 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10389 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10390 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10391 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10392 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10393 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10394 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10395 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10398 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10399 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10400 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10401 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10402 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10403 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10405 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10407 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10408 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10412 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10413 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10414 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10415 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10416 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10417 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10421 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10422 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10423 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10424 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10425 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10426 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10427 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10430 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10431 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10432 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10433 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10434 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10435 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10436 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10438 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10439 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10440 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10441 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10442 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10443 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10444 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10445 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10446 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10449 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10450 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10451 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10452 .cindex "lower casing"
10453 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10454 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10455 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10460 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10461 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10462 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10463 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10464 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10465 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10467 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10469 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10470 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10471 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10474 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10475 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10476 .cindex "list" "item count"
10477 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10478 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10479 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10482 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10483 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10484 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10485 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10486 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10487 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10488 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10489 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10490 matching list is returned.
10493 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10494 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10495 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10496 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10497 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10501 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10502 .cindex "masked IP address"
10503 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10504 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10505 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10506 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10507 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10508 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10509 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10510 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10511 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10513 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10515 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10516 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10517 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10518 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10520 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10524 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10526 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10529 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10531 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10532 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10533 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10534 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10535 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10537 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10538 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10541 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10542 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10543 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10544 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10545 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10546 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10548 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10550 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10553 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10554 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10555 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10556 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10557 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10558 is an empty string or
10559 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10560 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10561 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10562 respectively For example,
10570 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10571 variable or a message header.
10573 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10574 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10575 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10576 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10577 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10578 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10579 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10582 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10583 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10584 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10585 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10586 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10588 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10594 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10595 yields an unchanged string.
10598 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10599 .cindex "random number"
10600 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10601 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10602 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10603 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10604 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10605 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10606 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10607 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10611 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10612 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10613 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10614 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10615 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10616 for DNS. For example,
10618 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10619 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10624 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10628 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10629 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10630 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10631 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10632 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10633 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10634 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10635 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10636 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10639 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10641 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10642 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10646 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10647 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10648 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10649 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10650 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10651 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10652 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10653 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10655 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10656 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10657 to use this operator as well.
10661 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10662 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10663 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10664 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10665 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10666 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10667 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10670 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10671 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10672 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10673 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10674 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10675 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10676 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10678 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10679 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10682 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10683 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10684 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10685 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10686 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10687 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10689 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10691 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10692 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10695 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10696 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10697 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10698 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10699 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10700 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10702 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10704 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10705 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10706 with 256 being the default.
10708 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10709 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10710 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10711 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10714 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10715 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10716 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10717 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10718 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10719 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10720 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10721 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10722 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10723 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10724 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10725 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10726 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10728 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10729 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10730 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10732 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10733 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10734 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10738 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10739 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10740 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10741 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10742 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10743 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10746 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10747 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10748 .cindex "substring extraction"
10749 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10750 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10751 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10752 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10754 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10756 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10757 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10759 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10760 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10761 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10762 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10765 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10766 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10767 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10768 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10769 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10770 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10773 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10774 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10775 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10776 .cindex "upper casing"
10777 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10778 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10779 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10781 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10782 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10783 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10784 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10785 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10786 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10787 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10789 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10790 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10791 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10792 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10793 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10794 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10796 .cindex internationalisation
10797 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10798 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10799 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10800 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10801 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10802 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10810 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10811 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10812 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10813 while expanding strings:
10816 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10817 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10818 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10819 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10822 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10823 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10824 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10825 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10831 &`>= `& greater or equal
10833 &`<= `& less or equal
10837 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10839 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10840 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10841 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10842 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10843 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10846 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10847 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10848 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10851 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10852 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10853 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10854 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10855 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10856 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10857 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10858 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10859 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10860 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10861 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10862 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10863 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10864 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10866 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10867 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10868 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10869 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10870 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10871 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10873 An empty string is treated as false.
10874 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10875 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10876 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10878 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10879 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10882 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10886 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10887 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10888 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10889 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10890 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10891 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10892 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10893 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10895 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10897 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10898 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10899 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10900 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10901 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10902 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10903 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10904 included in the binary.
10906 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10907 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10908 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10909 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10910 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10911 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10912 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10913 string in LDAP form is:
10915 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10917 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10918 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10920 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10922 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10927 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10928 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10929 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10930 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10931 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10932 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10936 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10937 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10938 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10939 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10940 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10941 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10944 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10945 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10946 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10947 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10948 whatever its length.
10951 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10952 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10953 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10954 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10956 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10957 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10958 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10959 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10960 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10961 support &[crypt16()]&.
10963 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10964 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10965 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10966 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10967 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10969 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10970 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10971 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10973 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10974 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10975 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10976 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10977 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10979 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10980 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10981 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10982 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10983 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10984 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10986 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10988 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10989 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10991 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10992 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10993 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10994 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10995 exists in the message. For example,
10997 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10999 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11000 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11002 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11003 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11004 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11005 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11006 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11007 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11008 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11009 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11010 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
11012 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11013 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11014 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11015 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11016 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11017 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11018 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11019 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11021 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11022 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11023 .cindex "first delivery"
11024 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11025 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11026 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11027 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11030 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11031 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11032 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11033 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11034 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11036 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11037 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11038 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11039 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11040 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11042 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11043 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11044 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11046 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11047 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11048 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11050 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11051 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11052 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11053 list separator is changed to a comma:
11055 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11057 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11058 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11060 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11063 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11064 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11065 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11066 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11067 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11068 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11069 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11070 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11071 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11074 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11075 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11076 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11077 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11078 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11079 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11080 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11081 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11082 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11085 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11086 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11087 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11088 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11089 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11090 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11093 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11094 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11096 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11097 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11098 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11099 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11102 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11103 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11104 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11105 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11106 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11107 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11108 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11109 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11110 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11111 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11112 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11114 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11115 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11116 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11117 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11118 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11120 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11121 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11123 This is no longer the case.
11125 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11126 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11128 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11130 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11132 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11133 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11134 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11135 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11136 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11137 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11138 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11139 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11140 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11141 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11142 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11143 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11144 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11148 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11149 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11150 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11151 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11152 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11153 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11154 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11155 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11156 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11159 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11160 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11161 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11162 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11163 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11164 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11165 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11166 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11167 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11171 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11172 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11173 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11174 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11175 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11176 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11177 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11178 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11179 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11180 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11181 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11184 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11186 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11187 backslashes is also required.
11189 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11190 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11191 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11192 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11193 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11194 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11196 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11197 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11198 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11199 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11200 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11201 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11202 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11203 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11205 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11206 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11207 See &*match_local_part*&.
11209 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11210 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11211 See &*match_local_part*&.
11213 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11214 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11215 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11216 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11217 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11218 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11220 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11222 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11225 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11227 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11229 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11230 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11231 in a single test such as
11232 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11233 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11234 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11235 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11237 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11239 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11241 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11243 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11244 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11245 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11246 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11247 masks. For example:
11249 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11251 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11252 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11253 address mask, for example:
11255 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11257 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11258 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11260 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11264 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11265 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11267 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11269 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11270 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11271 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11272 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11273 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11274 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11275 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11276 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11279 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11281 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11282 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11283 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11284 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11286 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11288 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11289 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11290 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11291 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11294 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11295 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11297 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11298 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11299 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11300 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11302 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11303 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11304 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11305 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11306 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11307 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11308 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11309 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11310 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11311 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11312 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11316 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11317 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11319 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11320 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11321 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11322 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11323 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11324 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11325 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11327 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11328 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11329 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11330 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11331 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11333 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11335 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11337 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11339 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11340 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11341 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11342 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11343 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11344 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11345 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11346 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11349 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11350 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11352 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11353 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11354 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11355 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11356 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11357 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11359 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11360 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11361 building Exim. For example:
11363 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11365 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11366 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11367 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11368 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11370 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11371 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11372 configuration, you might have this:
11374 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11376 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11378 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11380 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11381 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11382 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11383 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11384 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11385 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11388 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11390 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11391 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11392 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11393 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11394 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11397 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11398 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11399 this library, you need to set
11401 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11403 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11404 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11406 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11408 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11409 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11410 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11412 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11413 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11414 the authentication is successful. For example:
11416 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11420 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11421 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11422 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11424 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11425 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11426 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11427 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11428 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11429 by a process that is not running as root.
11431 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11432 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11433 building Exim. For example:
11435 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11437 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11438 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11439 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11441 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11442 two are mandatory. For example:
11444 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11446 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11447 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11448 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11453 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11454 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11455 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11456 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11457 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11458 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11459 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11463 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11464 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11465 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11466 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11467 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11470 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11472 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11473 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11474 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11476 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11477 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11478 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11479 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11480 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11481 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11482 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11483 parsed but not evaluated.
11485 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11490 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11491 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11492 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11493 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11494 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11497 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11498 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11499 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11500 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11501 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11502 In the expansion condition case
11503 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11504 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11505 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11506 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11507 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11508 matching condition.
11510 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11511 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11512 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11513 any unused variables being made empty.
11515 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11516 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11517 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11518 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11519 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11520 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11521 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11522 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11523 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11524 during subsequent delivery.
11526 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11527 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11528 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11529 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11530 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11531 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11532 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11533 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11536 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11537 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11538 this variable has the number of arguments.
11540 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11541 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11542 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11543 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11544 be preserved by coding like this:
11546 warn !verify = sender
11547 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11549 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11550 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11553 .vitem &$address_data$&
11554 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11555 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11556 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11557 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11558 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11559 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11562 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11563 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11564 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11565 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11566 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11567 from the child's routing.
11569 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11570 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11571 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11574 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11575 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11576 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11578 .vitem &$address_file$&
11579 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11580 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11581 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11582 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11583 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11585 /home/r2d2/savemail
11587 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11588 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11589 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11590 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11591 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11592 to the relevant file.
11594 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11595 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11596 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11597 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11599 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11600 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11601 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11602 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11604 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11605 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11606 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11607 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11608 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11609 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11610 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11611 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11612 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11614 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11615 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11616 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11617 command line option.
11618 This second case also sets up inforamtion used by the
11619 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11621 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11622 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11623 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11624 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11625 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11626 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11627 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11628 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11629 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11633 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11634 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11635 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11636 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11637 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11638 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11639 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11640 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11641 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11642 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11643 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11645 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11646 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11647 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11648 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11649 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11652 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11653 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11654 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11655 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11656 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11657 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11658 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11659 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11660 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11661 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11662 an undefined mechanism.
11664 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11665 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11666 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11667 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11668 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11669 the ACL malware condition.
11671 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11672 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11673 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11674 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11675 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11676 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11678 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11679 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11680 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11681 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11682 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11683 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11684 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11686 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11687 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11688 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11689 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11690 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11692 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11693 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11694 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11695 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11696 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11698 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11699 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11700 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11701 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11702 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11703 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11704 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11706 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11707 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11708 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11709 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11710 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11711 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11712 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11714 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11715 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11716 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11717 address that was connected to.
11719 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11720 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11721 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11722 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11723 compilations of the same version of the program.
11725 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11726 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11727 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11728 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11729 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11730 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11732 .vitem &$config_file$&
11733 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11734 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11736 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11737 Results of DKIM verification.
11738 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11740 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11741 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11742 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11743 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11744 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11746 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11747 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11748 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11749 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11750 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11751 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11752 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11753 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11754 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11755 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11756 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11757 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11758 &$dkim_key_length$&
11759 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11760 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11762 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11763 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11764 When a message has been received this variable contains
11765 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11766 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11768 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11769 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11770 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11772 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11773 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11774 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11775 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11776 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11777 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11778 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11779 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11780 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11783 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11784 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11785 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11786 case for &$domain$&.
11788 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11789 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11790 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11791 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11793 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11794 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11795 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11796 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11797 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11798 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11800 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11801 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11802 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11804 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11807 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11808 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11809 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11810 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11811 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11812 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11813 the &(smtp)& transport.
11816 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11817 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11818 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11819 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11822 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11823 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11824 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11825 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11826 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11827 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11830 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11831 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11832 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11833 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11837 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11838 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11839 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11840 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11841 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11842 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11843 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11846 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11847 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11848 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11851 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11852 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11853 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11855 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11856 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11857 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11859 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11860 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11861 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11863 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11864 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11865 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11866 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11867 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11868 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11870 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11871 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11872 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11873 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11874 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11876 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11877 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11878 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11879 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11880 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11884 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11885 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11886 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11887 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11888 by a setting on the transport itself.
11890 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11891 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11892 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11896 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11897 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11898 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11899 to local and remote transports.
11901 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11902 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11903 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11904 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11905 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11906 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11907 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11910 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11911 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11912 client is connected.
11915 .vitem &$host_address$&
11916 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11917 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11918 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11919 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11921 .vitem &$host_data$&
11922 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11923 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11924 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11925 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11927 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11928 message = $host_data
11930 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11931 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11932 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11933 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11934 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11935 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11936 variables is set to &"1"&.
11939 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11940 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11943 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11944 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11945 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11948 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11949 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11950 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11951 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11952 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11953 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11954 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11955 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11956 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11957 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11959 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
11960 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
11961 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11964 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11965 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11966 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11968 .vitem &$host_port$&
11969 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11970 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11971 for an outbound connection.
11973 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11974 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11975 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11976 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11977 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11978 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11981 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11982 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11983 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11984 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11985 a unique name for the file.
11987 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11988 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11989 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11991 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11992 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11993 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11997 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11998 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11999 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12003 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12004 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12005 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12008 .vitem &$load_average$&
12009 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12010 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12011 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12012 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12014 .vitem &$local_part$&
12015 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12016 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12017 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12018 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12019 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12021 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12022 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12023 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12024 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12027 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12028 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12029 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12030 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12031 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12032 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12034 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12035 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12036 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12039 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12040 local part of the recipient address.
12042 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12043 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12044 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12046 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12049 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12050 abc\:xyz@test.example
12052 the value of &$local_part$& is
12056 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12057 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12060 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12062 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12063 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12064 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12066 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12067 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12068 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12069 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12070 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12071 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12072 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12074 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12075 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12076 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12077 variable expands to nothing.
12079 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12080 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12081 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12082 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12083 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12085 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12086 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12087 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12088 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12089 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12091 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12092 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12093 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12094 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12096 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12097 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12098 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12100 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12101 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12102 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12103 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12104 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12105 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12106 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12107 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12109 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12110 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12111 This contains the expanded value of the
12112 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12115 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12116 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12117 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12118 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12119 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12120 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12122 .vitem &$log_space$&
12123 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12124 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12125 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12126 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12127 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12128 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12131 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12132 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12133 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12134 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12135 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12136 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12137 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12138 and &"yes"& if it was.
12139 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12140 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12141 as authenticated data.
12143 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12144 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12145 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12146 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12147 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12148 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12149 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12152 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12153 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12154 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12155 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12156 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12158 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12159 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12160 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12161 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12162 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12163 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12165 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12167 .vitem &$message_age$&
12168 .cindex "message" "age of"
12169 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12170 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12171 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12174 .vitem &$message_body$&
12175 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12176 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12177 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12178 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12179 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12180 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12181 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12182 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12183 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12185 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12186 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12187 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12188 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12189 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12191 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12192 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12193 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12194 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12195 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12196 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12199 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12200 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12201 .cindex "message body" "size"
12202 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12203 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12204 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12205 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12206 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12208 If the spool file is wireformat
12209 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12210 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12212 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12213 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12214 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12215 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12216 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12217 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12218 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12219 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12221 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12222 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12223 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12224 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12225 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12226 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12228 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12229 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12230 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12231 contents of header lines is done.
12233 .vitem &$message_id$&
12234 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12236 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12237 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12238 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12239 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12240 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12241 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12242 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12243 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12244 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12245 from the body is not counted.
12247 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12248 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12249 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12250 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12251 header and the body).
12253 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12255 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12257 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12259 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12260 message has not yet been received.
12262 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12264 .vitem &$message_size$&
12265 .cindex "size" "of message"
12266 .cindex "message" "size"
12267 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12268 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12269 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12270 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12271 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12272 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12273 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12274 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12275 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12277 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12278 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12279 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12280 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12282 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12283 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12284 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12285 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12287 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12288 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12289 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12291 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12292 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12293 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12294 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12295 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12296 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12297 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12298 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12299 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12300 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12302 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12303 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12304 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12306 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12307 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12308 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12309 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12310 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12311 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12312 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12313 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12314 the original address.
12316 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12317 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12318 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12319 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12320 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12322 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12323 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12324 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12326 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12327 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12328 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12329 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12330 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12331 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12332 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12333 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12334 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12336 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12337 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12338 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12339 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12340 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12341 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12342 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12343 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12346 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12347 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12348 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12349 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12351 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12352 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12353 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12354 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12357 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12359 This variable contains the current process id.
12361 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12362 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12363 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12364 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12365 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12366 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12367 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12368 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12369 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12370 variable"& error if encountered.
12372 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12373 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12374 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12375 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12376 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12377 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12378 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12381 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12382 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12383 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12384 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12386 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12388 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12390 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12391 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12392 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12393 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12395 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12396 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12397 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12398 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12400 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12401 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12402 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12403 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12405 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12406 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12407 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12408 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12410 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12411 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12412 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12414 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12415 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12416 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12417 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12419 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12420 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12421 .cindex "named queues"
12422 .cindex queues named
12423 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12425 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12426 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12427 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12428 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12429 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12431 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12432 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12433 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12434 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12435 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12436 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12438 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12439 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12440 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12441 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12442 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12444 .vitem &$received_count$&
12445 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12446 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12447 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12448 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12451 .vitem &$received_for$&
12452 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12453 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12454 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12455 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12456 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12458 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12459 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12460 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12461 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12462 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12463 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12464 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12467 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12468 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12469 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12470 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12471 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12473 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12475 .vitem &$received_port$&
12476 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12477 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12479 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12480 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12481 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12482 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12483 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12484 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12485 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12486 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12487 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12489 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12490 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12491 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12492 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12493 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12494 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12496 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12497 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12498 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12500 .vitem &$received_time$&
12501 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12502 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12503 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12505 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12506 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12507 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12508 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12509 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12511 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12512 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12514 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12515 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12516 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12517 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12519 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12520 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12521 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12522 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12525 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12526 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12529 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12532 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12533 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12537 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12540 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12543 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12544 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12546 .vitem &$recipients$&
12547 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12548 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12549 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12550 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12551 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12555 In a system filter file.
12557 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12558 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12559 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12560 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12562 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12566 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12567 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12568 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12569 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12570 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12571 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12574 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12575 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12576 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12577 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12579 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12580 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12581 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12582 these variables contain the
12583 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12586 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12587 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12588 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12589 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12590 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12591 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12592 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12594 .vitem &$return_path$&
12595 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12596 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12597 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12598 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12599 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12600 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12601 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12602 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12603 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12604 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12607 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12608 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12609 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12611 .vitem &$router_name$&
12612 .cindex "router" "name"
12613 .cindex "name" "of router"
12614 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12615 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12618 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12619 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12620 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12621 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12622 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12623 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12624 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12627 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12628 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12629 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12630 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12631 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12632 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12633 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12634 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12636 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12637 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12638 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12639 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12640 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12641 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12643 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12644 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12645 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12646 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12647 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12648 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12649 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12650 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12652 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12653 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12654 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12656 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12657 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12658 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12660 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12661 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12662 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12663 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12664 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12667 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12668 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12670 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12671 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12672 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12673 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12675 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12676 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12677 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12678 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12679 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12680 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12681 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12682 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12683 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12684 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12685 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12686 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12687 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12689 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12690 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12691 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12692 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12693 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12695 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12696 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12697 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12698 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12699 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12700 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12702 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12703 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12704 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12705 this variable contains that
12706 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12708 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12709 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12710 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12711 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12712 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12713 &$authenticated_id$&.
12715 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12716 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12717 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12718 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12719 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12720 resolver library states that both
12721 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12722 other times, this variable is false.
12724 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12725 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12726 library, by setting:
12731 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12732 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12734 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12735 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12737 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12738 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12739 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12740 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12743 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12744 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12745 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12746 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12747 other means, this variable is empty.
12749 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12750 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12751 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12752 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12753 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12754 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12755 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12757 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12758 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12759 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12760 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12762 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12763 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12764 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12767 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12768 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12769 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12770 following are true:
12773 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12775 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12776 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12777 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12779 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12780 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12781 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12783 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12784 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12785 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12787 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12788 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12789 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12790 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12792 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12794 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12795 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12799 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12800 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12801 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12802 number that was used on the remote host.
12804 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12805 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12806 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12807 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12808 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12811 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12812 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12813 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12814 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12816 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12817 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12818 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12819 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12820 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12821 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12822 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12823 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12824 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12825 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12826 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12829 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12830 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12831 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12832 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12833 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12835 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12836 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12837 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12838 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12839 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12841 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12842 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12843 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12844 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12845 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12846 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12847 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12849 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12850 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12851 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12852 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12853 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12855 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12856 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12857 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12858 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12859 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12860 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12862 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12863 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12864 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12865 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12866 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12871 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12872 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12873 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12874 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12876 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12877 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12878 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12879 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12880 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12881 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12882 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12884 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12885 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12886 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12887 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12888 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12891 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12892 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12893 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12894 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12895 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12896 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12897 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12898 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12899 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12900 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12901 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12903 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12904 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12905 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12906 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12907 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12908 message is junk mail.
12910 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12911 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12912 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12913 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12915 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12916 &$spf_received$& &&&
12918 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
12919 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12920 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12921 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12923 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12924 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12925 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12927 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12928 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12929 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12930 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12931 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12932 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12934 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12935 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12936 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12937 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12938 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12939 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12940 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12941 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12943 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12945 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12948 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12949 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12950 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12951 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12952 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12953 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12955 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12956 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12957 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12958 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12959 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12960 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12961 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12962 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12964 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12965 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12968 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12969 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12970 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12971 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12972 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12973 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12975 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12976 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12977 .cindex certificate variables
12978 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12979 inbound connection when the message was received.
12980 It is only useful as the argument of a
12981 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12982 or a &%def%& condition.
12984 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
12985 when a list of more than one
12986 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12988 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12989 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12990 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12991 inbound connection when the message was received.
12992 It is only useful as the argument of a
12993 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12994 or a &%def%& condition.
12995 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12996 which is not the leaf.
12998 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12999 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13000 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13001 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13002 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13003 or a &%def%& condition.
13005 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13006 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13007 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13008 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13009 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13010 or a &%def%& condition.
13011 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13012 which is not the leaf.
13014 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13015 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13016 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13017 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13019 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13020 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13023 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13024 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13025 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13026 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13027 and &"0"& otherwise.
13029 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13030 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13031 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13032 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13033 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13034 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13035 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13036 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13037 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13039 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13040 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13041 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13043 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13044 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13046 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13047 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13048 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13049 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13051 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13052 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13053 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13055 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13056 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13057 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13058 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13060 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13061 1 No response to request
13062 2 Response not verified
13063 3 Verification failed
13064 4 Verification succeeded
13067 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13068 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13069 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13070 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13071 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13073 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13074 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13075 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13076 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13077 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13078 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13079 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13080 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13081 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13082 which is not the leaf.
13084 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13085 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13088 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13089 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13090 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13091 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13092 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13093 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13094 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13095 which is not the leaf.
13097 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13098 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13099 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13100 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13101 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13102 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13103 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13104 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13105 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13106 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13107 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13109 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13110 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13113 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13114 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13115 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13117 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13120 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13121 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13122 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13124 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13125 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13126 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13127 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13129 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13130 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13131 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13133 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13134 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13135 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13137 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13138 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13139 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13140 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13141 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13142 values for those that are behind (west).
13145 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13146 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13147 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13149 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13150 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13151 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13152 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13155 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13156 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13157 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13160 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13161 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13162 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13163 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13165 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13166 .cindex "transport" "name"
13167 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13168 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13169 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13172 .vindex "&$value$&"
13173 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13174 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13175 &*reduce*& expansion.
13177 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13178 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13179 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13180 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13183 .vitem &$version_number$&
13184 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13185 The version number of Exim.
13187 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13188 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13189 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13190 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13192 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13193 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13194 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13195 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13201 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13202 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13204 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13205 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13206 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13207 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13208 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13209 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13214 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13217 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13218 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13219 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13220 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13221 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13222 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13223 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13224 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13225 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13227 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13228 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13229 should usually be something like
13231 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13233 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13234 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13235 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13236 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13237 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13238 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13239 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13240 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13244 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13245 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13246 a startup when Exim is entered.
13248 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13249 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13252 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13253 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13256 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13257 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13258 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13259 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13260 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13261 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13265 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13266 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13267 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13268 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13272 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13273 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13275 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13276 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13277 with an error message of the form
13279 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13281 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13282 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13283 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13284 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13285 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13286 that was passed to &%die%&.
13289 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13290 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13291 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13294 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13296 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13297 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13298 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13300 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13301 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13302 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13303 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13305 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13306 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13307 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13308 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13309 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13310 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13311 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13314 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13315 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13316 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13317 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13318 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13319 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13320 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13321 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13322 avoided, but the output is lost.
13324 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13325 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13326 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13327 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13328 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13329 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13330 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13332 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13334 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13335 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13336 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13337 as the first subroutine argument.
13341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13342 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13344 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13345 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13346 "Starting the daemon"
13347 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13348 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13349 .cindex "network interface"
13350 .cindex "interface" "network"
13351 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13352 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13353 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13354 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13355 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13356 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13357 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13358 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13359 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13360 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13361 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13364 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13365 and ports to listen on.
13367 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13368 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13369 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13370 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13371 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13372 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13373 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13374 as an error situation.
13376 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13377 for the outgoing connection.
13381 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13382 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13383 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13384 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13385 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13387 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13388 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13389 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13390 chapter describes how they operate.
13392 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13393 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13397 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13398 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13399 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13403 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13405 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13407 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13408 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13411 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13412 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13413 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13414 colons. For example:
13416 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13419 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13421 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13422 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13425 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13426 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13428 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13429 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13432 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13433 with a colon separator, for example:
13435 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13436 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13440 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13441 default setting contains just one port:
13443 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13445 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13446 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13447 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13448 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13449 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13453 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13454 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13455 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13456 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13457 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13458 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13460 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13462 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13464 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13466 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13470 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13471 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13472 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13473 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13474 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13475 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13478 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13479 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13480 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13481 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13482 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13483 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13487 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13490 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13492 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13493 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13494 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13498 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13499 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13500 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13501 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13502 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13503 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13504 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13505 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13506 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13507 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13508 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13509 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13510 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13513 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13514 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13515 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13517 The common use of this option is expected to be
13519 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13522 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13523 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13525 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13526 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13527 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13528 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13529 connections via the daemon.)
13534 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13535 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13536 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13537 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13538 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13539 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13540 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13541 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13543 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13545 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13546 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13547 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13548 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13549 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13550 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13552 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13554 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13555 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13556 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13557 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13558 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13560 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13561 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13562 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13563 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13564 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13565 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13566 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13567 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13568 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13569 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13570 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13571 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13573 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13574 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13575 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13576 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13577 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13581 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13582 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13584 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13585 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13587 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13588 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13589 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13590 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13592 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13594 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13596 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13598 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13599 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13601 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13602 IPv4 loopback address only:
13604 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13606 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13608 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13610 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13614 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13615 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13616 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13617 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13620 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13621 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13622 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13623 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13625 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13626 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13627 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13628 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13629 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13630 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13631 used for listening. Consider this example:
13633 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13635 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13637 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13639 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13640 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13643 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13644 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13645 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13646 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13647 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13648 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13649 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13650 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13654 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13655 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13656 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13657 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13658 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13659 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13666 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13668 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13669 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13670 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13671 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13674 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13675 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13677 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13678 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13679 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13681 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13682 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13683 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13684 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13688 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13689 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13690 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13691 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13692 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13693 listed in more than one group.
13695 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13697 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13698 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13699 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13700 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13701 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13702 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13703 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13704 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13705 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13706 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13707 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13711 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13713 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13714 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13715 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13716 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13717 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13718 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13723 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13725 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13726 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13727 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13728 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13729 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13730 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13731 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13732 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13733 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13734 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13735 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13736 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13741 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13743 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13744 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13745 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13746 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13747 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13748 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13749 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13750 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13751 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13752 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13753 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13754 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13755 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13756 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13757 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13762 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13764 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13765 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13766 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13767 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13772 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13774 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13775 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13776 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13777 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13778 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13779 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13780 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13781 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13782 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13783 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13784 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13785 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13786 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13787 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13788 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13793 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13795 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13796 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13801 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13803 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13804 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13805 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13810 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13812 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13813 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13814 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13815 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13816 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13817 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13818 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13823 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13825 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13826 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13827 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13828 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13829 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13830 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13831 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13832 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13833 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13834 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13835 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13836 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13837 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13838 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13839 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13840 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13842 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13843 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13844 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13845 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13846 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13851 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13853 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13854 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13855 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13856 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13857 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13858 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13859 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13860 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13861 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13862 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13863 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13864 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13865 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13866 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13867 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13868 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13869 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13870 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13871 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13872 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13873 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13874 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13876 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13877 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13878 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13879 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13880 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13881 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13882 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13883 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13884 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13885 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13886 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13887 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13888 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13889 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13890 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13891 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13892 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13893 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13894 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13899 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13901 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13903 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13905 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13906 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13907 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13912 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13914 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13915 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13916 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13917 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13918 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13919 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13920 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13921 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13922 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13923 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13924 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13925 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13926 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13927 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13928 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13929 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13930 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13935 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13937 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13938 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13939 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13940 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13941 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13942 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13943 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13944 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13949 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13951 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13952 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13953 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13954 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13955 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13956 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13957 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13958 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13964 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13966 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13973 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13974 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13977 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13978 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13979 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13980 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13981 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13982 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13983 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13984 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13985 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13986 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13987 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13988 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13989 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13990 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13991 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13993 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13994 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13995 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13996 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13997 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13998 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13999 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14000 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14001 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14002 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14003 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14004 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14005 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14006 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14007 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14008 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14013 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14015 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14016 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14017 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14018 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14019 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14020 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14021 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14022 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14023 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14024 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14029 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14031 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14032 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14033 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14034 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14036 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14037 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14038 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14039 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14040 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14041 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14042 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14043 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14044 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14045 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14050 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14052 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14053 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14055 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14056 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14057 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14058 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14059 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14064 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14066 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14067 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14068 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14069 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14070 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14071 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14072 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14073 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14074 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14075 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14076 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14077 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14078 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14079 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14080 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14081 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14082 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14083 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14084 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14085 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14086 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14087 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14088 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14089 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14094 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14096 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14097 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14098 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14099 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14100 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14101 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14102 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14103 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14104 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14105 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14106 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14107 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14108 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14109 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14110 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14115 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14116 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14119 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14121 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14122 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14123 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14124 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14125 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14126 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14127 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14129 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14130 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14131 It now defaults to true.
14132 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14134 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14137 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14139 log_selector = +8bitmime
14142 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14143 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14144 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14145 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14146 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14149 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14150 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14151 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14154 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14155 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14156 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14157 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14158 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14160 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14161 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14162 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14163 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14164 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14166 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14167 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14168 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14169 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14171 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14172 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14173 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14174 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14175 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14177 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14178 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14179 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14180 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14181 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14182 This option defines the ACL that,
14183 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14184 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14185 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14186 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14188 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14189 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14190 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14191 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14192 of a received message.
14193 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14195 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14196 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14197 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14198 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14200 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14201 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14202 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14203 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14205 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14206 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14207 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14208 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14209 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14212 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14213 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14214 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14215 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14217 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14218 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14219 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14220 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14221 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14223 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14224 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14225 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14226 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14227 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14229 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14230 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14231 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14232 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14233 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14235 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14236 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14237 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14240 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14241 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14242 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14243 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14245 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14246 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14247 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14248 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14250 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14251 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14252 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14253 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14255 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14256 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14257 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14258 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14260 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14261 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14262 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14263 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14264 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14266 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14267 .cindex "admin user"
14268 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14269 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14270 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14271 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14272 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14273 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14274 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14276 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14277 .cindex "domain literal"
14278 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14279 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14280 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14281 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14283 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14284 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14285 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14286 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14287 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14288 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14289 the local host's IP addresses.
14292 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14293 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14294 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14295 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14296 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14297 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14298 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14299 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14300 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14302 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14303 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14304 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14305 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14306 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14307 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14308 experiment if they wish.
14310 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14311 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14312 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14313 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14314 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14315 suitable setting is:
14317 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14318 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14320 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14322 dns_check_names_pattern =
14324 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14327 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14328 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14329 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14330 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14331 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14332 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14333 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14334 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14335 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14336 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14337 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14339 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14340 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14341 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14342 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14343 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14344 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14346 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14347 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14348 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14349 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14351 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14353 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14354 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14355 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14356 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14359 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14360 .cindex "thawing messages"
14361 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14362 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14363 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14364 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14365 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14366 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14368 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14369 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14370 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14373 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14374 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14375 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14377 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14379 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14380 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14383 .option bi_command main string unset
14385 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14386 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14387 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14388 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14391 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14392 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14393 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14394 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14395 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14396 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14399 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14400 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14401 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14402 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14404 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14405 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14406 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14407 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14408 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14409 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14410 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14411 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14412 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14413 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14415 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14416 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14417 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14418 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14419 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14420 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14421 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14422 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14423 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14424 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14426 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14427 during reception of a message.
14428 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14430 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14433 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14434 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14435 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14436 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14439 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14440 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14441 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14442 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14443 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14444 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14445 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14446 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14447 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14449 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14450 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14451 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14452 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14453 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14456 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14457 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14458 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14459 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14460 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14461 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14462 connection. A typical setting might be:
14464 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14466 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14468 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14470 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14473 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14474 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14475 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14476 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14477 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14478 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14481 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14482 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14483 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14484 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14487 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14488 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14489 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14490 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14493 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14494 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14495 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14496 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14499 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14500 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14501 callout verification. The default value is
14503 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14505 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14508 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14509 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14512 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14513 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14515 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14516 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14517 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14518 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14519 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14520 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14521 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14522 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14523 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14524 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14527 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14528 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14531 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14532 .cindex "checking disk space"
14533 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14534 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14535 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14536 message is accepted.
14538 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14539 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14540 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14541 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14542 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14543 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14544 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14545 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14548 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14549 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14551 check_spool_space = 100M
14552 check_spool_inodes = 100
14554 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14555 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14558 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14559 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14560 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14562 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14563 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14564 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14565 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14566 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14567 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14569 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14570 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14571 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14573 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14574 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14575 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14577 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14578 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14579 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14580 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14582 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14583 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14584 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14585 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14587 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14589 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14590 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14591 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14592 administrative user.
14593 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14595 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14596 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14597 .cindex memory debugging
14598 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14599 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14600 it should normally be left as default.
14602 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14603 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14604 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14605 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14606 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14607 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14609 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14610 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14611 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14612 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14613 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14614 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14615 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14617 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14618 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14620 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14621 .cindex "warning of delay"
14622 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14623 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14624 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14625 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14626 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14627 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14628 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14629 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14632 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14634 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14635 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14636 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14637 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14641 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14642 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14644 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14646 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14647 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14648 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14650 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14651 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14652 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14653 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14654 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14655 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14656 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14657 not sent. The default is:
14659 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14660 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14661 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14662 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14665 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14666 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14667 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14668 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14670 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14671 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14672 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14673 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14674 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14675 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14676 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14677 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14679 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14680 .cindex "load average"
14681 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14682 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14683 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14684 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14685 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14688 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14689 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14690 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14691 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14692 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14693 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14694 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14695 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14697 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14698 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14699 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14700 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14701 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14702 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14703 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14704 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14706 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14707 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14708 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14709 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14712 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14713 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14714 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14715 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14716 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14717 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14718 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14721 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14722 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14723 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14724 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14725 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14726 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14729 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14730 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14731 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14732 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14733 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14734 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14735 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14736 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14737 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14738 by a setting such as this:
14740 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14742 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14743 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14744 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14745 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14746 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14747 options are applied after this global option.
14749 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14750 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14751 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14752 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14753 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14754 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14755 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14756 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14757 value of this option. The default pattern is
14759 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14760 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14762 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14763 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14764 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14765 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14766 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14769 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14770 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14771 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14773 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14774 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14775 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14776 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14779 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14780 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14781 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14782 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14783 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14784 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14786 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14789 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14790 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14791 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14792 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14793 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14794 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14795 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14796 domain matches this list.
14798 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14799 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14800 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14803 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14804 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14805 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14806 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14807 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14808 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14809 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14810 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14811 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14812 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14813 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14814 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14816 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14819 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14820 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14823 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14824 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14825 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14826 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14827 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14828 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14829 match with this expanded domain list.
14831 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14832 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14833 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14834 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14835 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14836 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14838 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14839 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14840 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14842 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14843 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14844 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14845 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14846 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14848 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14849 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14850 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14851 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14852 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14853 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14854 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14855 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14858 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14860 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14861 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14862 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14865 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14866 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14867 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14868 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14870 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14871 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14872 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14873 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14874 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14875 and accepted from, these hosts.
14876 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14877 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14878 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14879 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14882 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14883 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14884 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14885 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14886 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14887 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14889 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14891 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14892 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14894 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14895 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14896 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14897 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14898 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14899 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14900 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14901 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14902 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14905 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14906 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14907 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14908 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14909 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14910 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14911 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14912 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14913 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14915 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14916 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14917 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14918 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14919 are examined. For example:
14921 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14922 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14923 postmaster@mydomain.example
14925 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14926 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14927 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14928 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14929 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14930 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14931 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14934 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14935 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14936 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14938 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14940 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14941 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14942 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14943 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14944 overrides the default.
14946 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14947 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14948 and warning messages. For example:
14950 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14952 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14953 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14954 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14955 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14959 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14961 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14962 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14965 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14966 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14967 .cindex "Exim group"
14968 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14969 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14970 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14971 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14972 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14976 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14977 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14978 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14979 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14980 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14981 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14983 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14984 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14985 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14986 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14989 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14990 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14991 .cindex "Exim user"
14992 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14993 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14994 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14995 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14997 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14998 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14999 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15000 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15003 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15004 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15005 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15006 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15009 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15010 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15012 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15013 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15015 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15016 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15017 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15018 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15019 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15020 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15021 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15022 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15023 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15024 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15028 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15029 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15030 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15031 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15032 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15033 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15034 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15035 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15038 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15039 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15040 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15041 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15045 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15046 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15047 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15048 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15049 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15050 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15051 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15052 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15053 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15054 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15055 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15056 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15057 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15058 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15059 logging that you require.
15062 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15064 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15065 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15066 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15067 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15068 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15069 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15070 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15071 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15073 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15074 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15075 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15078 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15079 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15080 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15081 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15083 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15087 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15088 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15091 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15092 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15093 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15094 implementations of TLS.
15097 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15098 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15099 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15102 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15107 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15108 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15109 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15110 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15111 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15112 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15116 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15117 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15118 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15119 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15120 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15121 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15122 sections are rejected.
15125 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15126 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15127 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15128 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15129 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15130 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15131 zero means &"no limit"&.
15136 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15137 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15138 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15139 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15140 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15141 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15142 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15143 if you want to do semantic checking.
15144 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15148 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15149 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15150 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15151 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15152 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15153 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15154 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15156 helo_allow_chars = _
15158 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15161 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15162 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15163 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15164 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15165 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15166 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15167 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15171 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15172 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15173 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15174 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15175 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15176 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15177 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15178 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15179 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15180 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15181 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15182 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15184 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15185 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15186 EHLO command either:
15189 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15191 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15192 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15193 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15194 calling host address, or
15196 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15199 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15200 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15201 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15203 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15204 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15205 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15207 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15208 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15209 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15210 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15211 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15212 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15213 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15214 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15215 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15218 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15219 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15220 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15221 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15222 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15223 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15224 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15225 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15226 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15228 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15229 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15230 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15231 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15232 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15234 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15235 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15236 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15237 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15240 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15241 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15242 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15243 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15244 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15245 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15246 default configuration file contains
15250 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15251 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15253 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15254 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15255 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15257 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15258 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15259 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15260 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15261 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15262 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15265 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15266 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15267 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15268 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15269 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15272 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15273 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15274 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15275 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15279 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15280 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15281 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15282 as soon as the connection is made.
15283 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15284 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15285 connections immediately.
15287 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15288 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15289 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15290 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15291 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15294 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15295 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15296 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15297 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15298 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15299 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15300 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15301 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15302 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15304 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15306 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15310 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15311 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15312 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15313 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15316 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15317 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15318 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15319 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15320 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15322 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15323 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15325 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15326 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15327 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15328 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15329 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15330 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15331 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15334 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15335 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15336 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15337 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15338 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15342 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15343 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15344 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15345 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15346 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15347 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15349 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15350 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15351 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15352 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15353 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15354 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15355 for frozen messages. For example,
15357 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15359 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15360 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15361 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15362 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15363 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15364 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15367 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15368 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15369 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15370 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15371 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15372 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15373 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15374 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15375 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15376 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15379 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15380 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15382 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15383 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15384 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15385 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15386 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15387 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15388 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15389 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15390 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15392 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15393 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15395 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15396 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15397 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15398 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15400 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15401 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15402 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15405 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15406 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15407 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15411 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15412 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15413 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15414 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15418 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15419 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15420 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15421 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15422 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15423 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15424 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15425 and constrained to be a directory.
15428 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15429 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15430 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15431 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15432 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15433 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15434 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15435 and constrained to be a file.
15438 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15439 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15440 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15441 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15442 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15443 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15446 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15447 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15448 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15449 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15450 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15451 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15452 identity to be proven.
15455 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15456 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15457 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15458 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15459 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15462 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15463 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15464 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15465 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15466 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15470 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15471 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15472 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15473 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15474 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15475 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15479 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15480 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15481 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15482 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15483 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15485 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15486 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15487 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15490 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15491 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15492 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15493 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15494 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15495 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15496 has been built with LDAP support.
15500 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15501 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15502 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15503 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15504 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15505 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15506 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15508 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15509 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15510 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15512 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15513 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15514 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15515 and the default qualify domain.
15517 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15518 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15519 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15520 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15522 .cindex "envelope sender"
15523 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15524 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15525 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15527 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15528 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15529 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15534 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15535 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15536 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15537 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15538 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15539 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15540 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15543 local_from_prefix = *-
15545 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15547 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15549 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15550 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15554 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15555 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15558 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15559 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15560 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15561 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15562 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15563 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15564 &%local_interfaces%& is
15566 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15568 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15570 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15573 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15574 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15575 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15576 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15577 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15578 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15579 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15580 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15584 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15585 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15586 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15587 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15588 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15589 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15590 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15591 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15596 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15597 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15598 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15599 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15600 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15601 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15602 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15603 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15604 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15605 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15606 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15607 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15608 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15609 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15610 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15614 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15615 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15616 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15617 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15618 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15619 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15620 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15621 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15622 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15623 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15624 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15625 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15626 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15627 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15628 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15631 .option log_selector main string unset
15632 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15633 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15634 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15635 minus characters. For example:
15637 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15639 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15640 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15643 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15644 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15645 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15646 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15647 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15648 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15649 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15650 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15651 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15652 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15653 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15654 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15655 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15658 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15659 .cindex "too many open files"
15660 .cindex "open files, too many"
15661 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15662 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15663 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15664 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15665 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15666 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15667 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15668 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15669 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15670 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15671 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15672 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15675 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15676 .cindex "length of login name"
15677 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15678 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15679 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15680 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15681 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15682 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15685 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15686 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15687 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15688 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15689 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15690 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15691 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15692 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15695 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15696 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15697 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15698 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15699 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15700 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15701 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15704 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15705 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15706 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15707 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15708 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15709 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15710 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15711 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15712 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15713 empty string, the option is ignored.
15716 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15717 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15718 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15719 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15720 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15721 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15722 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15723 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15724 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15725 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15726 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15727 colons will become hyphens.
15730 .option message_logs main boolean true
15731 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15732 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15733 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15734 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15735 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15736 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15737 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15738 which is not affected by this option.
15741 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15742 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15743 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15744 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15745 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15746 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15747 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15748 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15749 optionally followed by K or M.
15751 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15752 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15753 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15754 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15755 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15757 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15758 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15759 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15760 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15761 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15762 message that an individual transport can process.
15764 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15765 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15766 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15767 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15768 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15769 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15770 some problems may result.
15772 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15773 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15774 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15777 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15778 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15779 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15781 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15783 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15784 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15785 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15786 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15787 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15790 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15791 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15792 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15793 contains a full description of this facility.
15797 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15798 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15799 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15800 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15801 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15804 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15805 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15806 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15807 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15808 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15811 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15812 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15813 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15814 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15815 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15817 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15818 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15821 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15823 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15824 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15828 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15829 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15830 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15831 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15832 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15834 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15835 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15836 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15837 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15838 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15839 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15840 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15842 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15843 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15844 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15845 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15846 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15848 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15850 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15851 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15852 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15853 some now infamous attacks.
15857 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15858 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15859 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15861 # Disable older protocol versions:
15862 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15865 Possible options may include:
15869 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15871 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15873 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15877 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15879 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15881 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15883 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15885 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15887 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15891 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15905 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15909 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15911 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15913 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15915 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15919 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15922 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15923 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15924 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15925 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15926 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15927 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15930 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15931 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15932 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15933 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15934 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15937 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15938 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15939 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15940 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15941 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15942 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15943 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15944 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15945 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15946 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15949 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15950 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15951 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15952 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15953 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15954 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15955 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15958 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15960 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15961 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15964 .option perl_startup main string unset
15966 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15967 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15969 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15971 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15974 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15975 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15976 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15977 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15978 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15979 PostgreSQL support.
15982 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15983 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15984 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15985 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15986 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15989 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15991 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15993 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15994 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15995 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15998 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15999 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16000 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16001 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16002 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16003 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16004 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16005 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16006 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16009 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16010 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16011 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16012 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16013 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16014 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16015 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16016 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16018 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16019 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16020 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16021 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16022 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16023 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16024 volume of mail. Use with care!
16027 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16028 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16029 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16030 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16031 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16032 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16033 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16034 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16035 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16036 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16038 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16039 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16040 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16041 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16042 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16043 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16046 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16047 .cindex "printing characters"
16048 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16049 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16050 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16051 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16052 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16053 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16056 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16057 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16058 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16059 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16060 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16064 .option process_log_path main string unset
16065 .cindex "process log path"
16066 .cindex "log" "process log"
16067 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16068 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16069 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16070 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16071 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16072 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16073 different spool directories.
16076 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16077 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16081 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16082 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16083 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16086 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16087 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16088 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16089 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16090 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16091 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16092 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16093 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16094 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16096 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16097 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16098 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16099 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16100 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16101 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16102 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16105 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16106 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16107 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16111 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16112 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16113 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16114 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16115 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16116 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16117 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16118 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16121 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16122 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16124 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16125 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16126 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16127 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16130 .option queue_only main boolean false
16131 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16132 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16133 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16134 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16135 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16136 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16138 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16139 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16140 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16141 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16144 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16145 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16146 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16147 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16148 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16149 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16150 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16151 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16152 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16154 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16156 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16157 &_/some/file_& exists.
16160 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16161 .cindex "load average"
16162 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16163 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16164 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16165 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16166 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16167 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16168 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16171 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16172 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16173 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16174 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16177 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16178 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16179 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16180 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16181 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16182 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16183 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16184 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16185 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16186 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16187 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16188 re-evaluated for each message.
16191 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16192 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16193 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16194 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16195 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16196 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16199 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16200 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16201 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16202 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16203 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16204 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16205 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16206 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16207 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16208 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16209 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16210 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16211 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16215 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16216 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16217 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16218 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16219 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16220 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16221 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16222 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16223 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16225 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16226 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16227 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16228 the daemon's command line.
16230 .cindex queues named
16231 .cindex "named queues"
16232 To set limits for different named queues use
16233 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16235 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16236 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16237 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16238 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16239 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16240 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16241 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16242 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16243 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16244 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16245 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16246 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16247 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16251 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16252 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16253 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16254 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16255 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16256 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16257 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16259 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16260 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16261 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16262 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16263 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16264 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16265 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16266 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16267 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16268 header lines. The default setting is:
16271 received_header_text = Received: \
16272 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16273 {${if def:sender_ident \
16274 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16275 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16276 by $primary_hostname \
16277 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16278 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16279 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16280 ${if def:sender_address \
16281 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16282 id $message_exim_id\
16283 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16286 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16287 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16288 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16289 header lines such as the following:
16291 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16292 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16293 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16294 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16295 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16296 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16297 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16299 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16300 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16301 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16302 message was accepted.
16305 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16306 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16307 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16308 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16309 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16310 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16311 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16312 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16315 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16316 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16317 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16318 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16319 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16320 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16321 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16322 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16323 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16324 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16325 option was not set.
16328 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16329 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16330 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16331 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16332 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16333 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16334 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16335 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16338 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16339 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16340 RCPT commands in a single message.
16343 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16344 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16345 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16346 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16347 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16348 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16349 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16352 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16353 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16354 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16355 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16356 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16357 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16358 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16359 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16360 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16361 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16362 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16363 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16364 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16365 tagged with its process id.
16367 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16368 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16369 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16370 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16373 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16374 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16375 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16376 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16377 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16378 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16379 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16380 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16381 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16382 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16383 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16385 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16386 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16387 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16388 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16391 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16392 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16393 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16394 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16395 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16397 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16399 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16400 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16403 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16404 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16405 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16406 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16407 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16411 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16412 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16413 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16414 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16415 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16416 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16417 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16421 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16422 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16423 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16424 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16425 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16426 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16427 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16428 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16429 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16430 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16433 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16434 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16437 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16439 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16440 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16441 an item in the list.
16442 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16445 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16446 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16447 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16448 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16449 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16452 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16453 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16454 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16455 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16456 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16457 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16458 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16459 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16460 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16461 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16463 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16464 .cindex "environment"
16465 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16466 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16467 default list is empty,
16470 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16471 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16472 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16473 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16474 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16475 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16476 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16480 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16481 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16482 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16483 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16484 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16485 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16486 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16487 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16488 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16489 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16490 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16494 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16495 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16496 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16498 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16499 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16500 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16501 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16502 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16503 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16505 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16506 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16507 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16508 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16511 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16512 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16513 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16514 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16515 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16516 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16517 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16518 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16520 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16521 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16522 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16523 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16524 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16525 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16526 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16527 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16530 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16531 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16532 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16533 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16537 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16538 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16539 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16540 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16541 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16542 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16543 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16544 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16545 . the option name to split.
16547 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16548 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16549 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16550 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16551 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16552 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16553 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16554 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16555 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16559 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16560 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16561 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16562 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16563 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16564 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16565 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16566 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16567 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16568 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16569 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16571 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16572 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16573 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16574 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16575 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16576 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16580 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16581 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16582 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16583 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16584 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16585 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16586 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16587 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16588 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16589 to all messages received in the same connection.
16591 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16592 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16593 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16594 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16597 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16599 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16600 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16601 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16602 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16603 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16604 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16605 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16606 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16607 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16608 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16609 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16610 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16611 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16614 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16615 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16616 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16617 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16618 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16619 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16620 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16621 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16622 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16623 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16624 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16627 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16628 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16629 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16630 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16633 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16634 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16635 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16636 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16637 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16638 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16639 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16640 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16641 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16643 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16644 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16645 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16646 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16648 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16649 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16650 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16651 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16652 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16655 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16656 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16659 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16660 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16661 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16662 &%helo_data%& value.
16664 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16665 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16666 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16667 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16668 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16669 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16670 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16672 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16673 $version_number $tod_full
16675 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16676 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16677 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16678 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16679 multiline response).
16682 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16683 .cindex "checking disk space"
16684 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16685 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16686 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16687 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16688 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16689 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16690 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16693 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16694 .cindex "connection backlog"
16695 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16696 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16697 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16698 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16699 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16700 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16701 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16702 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16703 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16704 attacks by SYN flooding.
16707 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16708 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16709 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16710 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16711 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16712 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16713 fewer, but they still exist.
16715 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16716 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16717 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16718 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16719 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16720 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16721 does detect many instances.
16723 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16724 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16725 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16726 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16730 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16731 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16732 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16733 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16734 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16735 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16736 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16737 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16740 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16741 $sender_host_address
16743 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16744 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16745 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16746 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16747 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16751 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16752 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16753 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16754 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16755 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16758 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16759 .cindex "load average"
16760 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16761 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16762 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16763 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16764 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16765 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16769 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16770 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16771 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16772 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16773 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16775 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16777 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16778 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16779 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16780 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16781 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16783 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16784 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16785 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16786 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16787 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16788 not count towards the limit.
16792 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16793 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16794 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16795 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16796 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16799 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16800 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16804 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16805 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16806 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16807 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16808 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16809 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16812 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16813 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16814 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16815 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16817 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16818 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16819 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16820 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16824 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16826 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16827 fractional parts are allowed here.
16829 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16831 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16832 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16835 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16836 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16838 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16839 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16841 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16842 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16843 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16844 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16847 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16848 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16851 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16852 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16855 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16856 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16857 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16858 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16859 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16860 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16861 the message is abandoned.
16862 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16864 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16865 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16867 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16868 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16870 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16871 expanded before use and may depend on
16872 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16876 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16877 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16878 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16879 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16880 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16883 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16884 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16885 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16888 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16889 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16890 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16891 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16892 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16893 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16894 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16895 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16896 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16897 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16899 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16900 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16904 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16905 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16906 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16907 the availability thereof is advertised in
16908 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16909 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16912 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
16913 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16914 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16915 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16919 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
16920 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
16921 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
16925 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16926 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16927 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16928 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16929 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16930 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16931 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16932 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16933 arrival of the message.
16935 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16936 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16937 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16938 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16939 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16941 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16942 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16943 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16944 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16945 automatically deleted.
16947 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16948 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16949 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16950 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16951 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16952 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16953 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16954 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16955 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16958 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16959 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16960 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16961 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16962 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16963 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16964 &$primary_hostname$&.
16966 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16967 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16968 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16969 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16970 as failures in the configuration file.
16972 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16973 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16975 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16976 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16977 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
16978 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16979 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16980 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
16983 The following variables will not have useful values:
16985 $max_received_linelength
16990 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16991 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16992 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16993 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
16995 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16996 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
16997 The transmission benefit is maintained.
16999 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17000 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17001 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17002 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17004 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17005 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17006 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17007 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17008 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17009 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17011 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17012 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17013 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17014 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17015 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17016 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17017 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17020 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17021 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17022 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17023 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17024 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17025 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17026 domain causes a syntax error.
17027 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17031 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17032 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17033 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17034 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17035 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17036 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17037 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17038 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17039 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17040 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17041 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17042 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17045 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17046 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17047 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17048 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17049 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17050 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17051 details of Exim's logging.
17054 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17055 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17056 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17057 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17058 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17059 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17060 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17064 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17065 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17066 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17067 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17068 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17072 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17073 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17074 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17075 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17076 details of Exim's logging.
17079 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17080 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17081 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17082 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17083 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17084 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17085 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17086 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17087 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17088 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17089 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17090 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17093 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17094 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17095 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17096 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17097 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17098 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17101 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17102 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17103 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17104 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17105 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17107 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17108 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17109 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17110 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17111 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17113 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17114 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17115 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17116 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17117 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17118 contains the pipe command.
17121 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17122 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17123 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17124 is used in a system filter.
17127 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17128 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17129 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17130 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17131 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17132 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17133 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17134 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17135 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17136 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17138 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17139 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17140 transport option overrides.
17143 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17144 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17145 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17146 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17147 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17148 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17149 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17150 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17151 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17152 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17153 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17154 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17158 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17159 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17160 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17161 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17162 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17163 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17164 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17165 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17166 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17167 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17169 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17170 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17171 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17174 .option timezone main string unset
17175 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17176 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17177 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17178 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17179 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17180 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17184 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17185 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17186 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17187 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17188 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17189 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17192 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17193 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17194 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17195 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17196 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17197 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17198 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17199 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17200 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17201 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17202 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17205 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17206 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17207 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17208 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17209 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17211 The server's private key is also
17212 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17213 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17215 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17216 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17217 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17218 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17220 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17221 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17223 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17224 when a list of more than one
17225 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17227 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17228 when a list of more than one file is used.
17230 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17231 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17232 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17233 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17235 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17236 generated for every connection.
17238 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17239 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17240 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17241 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17242 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17244 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17246 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17247 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17248 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17250 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17253 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17254 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17255 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17256 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17257 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17258 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17260 The value must be at least 1024.
17262 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17263 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17264 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17266 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17269 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17270 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17271 larger prime than requested.
17274 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17275 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17276 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17277 to be used by Exim.
17279 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17280 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17281 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17282 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17284 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17285 then it names a file from which DH
17286 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17287 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17288 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17289 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17290 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17291 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17293 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17296 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17297 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17298 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17299 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17301 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17302 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17304 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17305 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17306 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17308 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17309 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17310 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17311 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17312 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17314 The available standard primes are:
17315 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17316 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17317 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17318 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17320 The available additional primes are:
17321 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17323 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17324 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17325 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17326 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17327 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17329 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17330 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17331 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17333 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17334 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17335 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17336 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17337 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17340 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17341 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17342 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17343 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17344 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17345 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17346 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17349 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17350 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17351 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17352 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17354 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17355 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17356 for valid selections.
17358 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17359 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17360 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17362 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17365 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17366 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17367 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17369 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17370 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17371 Certificate Authority.
17373 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17375 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17376 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17377 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17380 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17383 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17384 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17385 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17386 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17390 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17391 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17392 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17393 files which contains the server's private keys.
17394 If this option is unset, or if
17395 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17396 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17397 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17399 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17402 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17403 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17404 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17405 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17406 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17407 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17411 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17412 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17413 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17414 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17415 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17416 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17417 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17418 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17419 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17420 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17421 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17424 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17425 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17426 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17427 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17430 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17431 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17432 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17433 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17435 or the absolute path to
17436 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17437 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17439 The "system" value for the option will use a
17440 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17441 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17442 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17445 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17446 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17448 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17450 either by file or directory
17451 are added to those given by the system default location.
17453 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17454 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17455 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17456 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17457 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17458 use the explicit directory version.
17460 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17462 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17466 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17467 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17468 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17469 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17470 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17471 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17472 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17473 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17475 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17476 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17477 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17478 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17479 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17480 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17481 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17483 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17484 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17485 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17486 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17487 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17488 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17489 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17492 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17496 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17497 .cindex "trusted groups"
17498 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17499 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17500 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17501 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17502 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17503 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17504 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17507 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17508 .cindex "trusted users"
17509 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17510 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17511 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17512 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17513 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17514 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17515 Exim user are trusted.
17517 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17518 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17519 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17520 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17521 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17522 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17523 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17524 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17525 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17528 .option unknown_username main string unset
17529 See &%unknown_login%&.
17531 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17532 .cindex "trusted users"
17533 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17534 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17535 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17536 .cindex "envelope sender"
17537 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17538 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17539 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17540 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17541 is used) is ignored.
17543 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17544 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17546 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17548 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17549 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17550 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17551 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17552 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17553 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17554 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17555 followed by a hyphen
17556 by a setting like this:
17558 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17560 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17561 restriction, you can use
17563 untrusted_set_sender = *
17565 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17566 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17567 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17568 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17569 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17570 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17571 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17572 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17574 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17575 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17576 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17577 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17581 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17582 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17583 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17584 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17585 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17586 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17587 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17588 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17589 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17590 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17592 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17593 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17595 The pattern can be seen by running
17597 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17599 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17600 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17601 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17602 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17603 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17604 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17607 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17608 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17611 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17612 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17613 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17614 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17615 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17616 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17617 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17618 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17621 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17622 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17623 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17624 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17625 .ecindex IIDconfima
17626 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17632 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17634 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17635 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17636 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17637 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17638 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
17640 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17641 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17642 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17643 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17644 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17648 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17649 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17650 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17651 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17652 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17653 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17654 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17656 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17657 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17658 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17659 routers, and the eventual transport.
17661 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17662 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17663 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17664 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17665 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17667 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17668 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17669 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17670 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17671 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17673 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17674 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17675 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17677 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17679 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17681 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17683 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17684 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17686 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17687 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17688 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17689 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17690 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17691 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17692 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17696 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17698 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17699 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17700 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17701 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17702 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17707 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17708 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17709 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17710 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17711 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17712 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17713 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17714 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17715 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17716 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17719 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17721 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17724 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17726 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17727 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17728 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17729 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17732 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17733 .cindex "case of local parts"
17734 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17735 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17736 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17737 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17738 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17739 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17740 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17743 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17744 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17745 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17746 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17747 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17748 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17749 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17750 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17751 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17753 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17754 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17755 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17756 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17760 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17761 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17762 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17763 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17765 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17766 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17767 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17768 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17769 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17770 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17771 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17772 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17773 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17774 the router is skipped.
17776 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17777 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17778 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17779 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17780 setting to achieve this. For example:
17782 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17784 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17785 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17786 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17790 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17791 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17792 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17793 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17794 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17795 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17796 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17797 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17799 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17800 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17802 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17803 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17805 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17806 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17807 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17809 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17811 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17813 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17816 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17818 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17819 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17823 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17824 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17825 be specified using &%condition%&.
17827 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17828 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17829 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17830 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17831 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17832 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17833 Router rules processing behavior.
17835 This is best illustrated in an example:
17837 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17838 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17840 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17843 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17846 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17847 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17848 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17849 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17850 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17851 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17852 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17853 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17855 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17856 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17857 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17858 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17861 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17862 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17863 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17864 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17865 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17868 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17869 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17870 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17871 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17872 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17873 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17874 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17875 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17876 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17877 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17878 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17879 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17880 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17881 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17885 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17886 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17887 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17888 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17889 transport option of the same name.
17891 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17892 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17893 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17894 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17895 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17896 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17897 the dnssec request bit set.
17898 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17900 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17901 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17902 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17903 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17904 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17905 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17906 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17907 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17908 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17911 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17912 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17913 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17914 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17915 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17916 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17917 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17918 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17922 .option driver routers string unset
17923 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17927 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17928 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17929 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17930 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17931 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17932 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17933 Not effective on redirect routers.
17937 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17938 .cindex "envelope sender"
17939 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17940 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17941 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17942 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17943 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17944 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17945 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17947 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17948 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17949 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17952 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17953 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17954 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17955 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17957 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17958 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17959 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17960 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17966 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17967 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17968 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17969 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17970 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17972 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17973 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17974 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17975 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17976 setting &%return_path%&.
17978 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17979 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17980 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17984 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17985 .cindex "address" "testing"
17986 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17987 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17988 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17989 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17990 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17991 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17992 on for the system alias file.
17993 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17996 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17997 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17998 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18002 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18003 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18004 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18005 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18009 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18010 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18011 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18015 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18016 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18017 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18021 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18022 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18023 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18024 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18025 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18026 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
18027 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18028 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18029 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18031 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18032 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18033 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18034 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18035 transport for further details.
18038 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18039 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18040 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18041 .cindex "transport" "local"
18042 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18043 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18044 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18046 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18047 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18048 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18049 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18050 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18054 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18055 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18056 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18057 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18058 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18059 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18060 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18061 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18062 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18063 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18064 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18065 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18066 &"see"& the added header lines.
18068 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18069 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18070 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18071 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18073 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18074 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18076 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18077 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18079 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18080 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18081 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18082 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18083 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18084 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18085 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18086 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18087 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18088 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18092 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18093 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18094 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18095 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18096 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18097 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18098 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18099 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18100 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18101 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18102 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18103 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18104 &"see"& the original header lines.
18106 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18107 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18108 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18111 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18112 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18114 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18115 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18117 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18118 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18119 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18120 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18122 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18123 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18124 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18128 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18129 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18130 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18131 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18132 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18133 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18134 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18137 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18141 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18143 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18144 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18145 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18146 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18147 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18148 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18150 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18151 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18153 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18154 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18156 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18157 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18159 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18160 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18161 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18162 domain that is being routed.
18164 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18165 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18168 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18169 .cindex "additional groups"
18170 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18171 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18172 .cindex "transport" "local"
18173 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18174 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18175 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18176 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18177 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18181 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18182 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18183 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18184 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18185 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18186 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18189 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18190 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18191 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18192 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18193 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18194 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18195 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18196 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18197 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18199 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18200 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18201 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18202 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18203 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18204 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18205 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18206 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18207 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18208 the relevant transport.
18210 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18211 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18212 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18215 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18216 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18217 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18218 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18219 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18223 local_part_prefix = real-
18225 transport = local_delivery
18227 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18228 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18230 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18231 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18234 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18235 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18236 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18237 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18240 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18241 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18245 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18246 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18247 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18248 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18249 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18250 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18251 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18252 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18253 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18257 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18258 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18262 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18263 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18264 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18265 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18266 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18268 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18269 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18272 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18274 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18275 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18276 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18277 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18278 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18279 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18280 each virtual domain:
18284 local_parts = postmaster
18285 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18289 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18290 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18291 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18292 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18293 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18294 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18295 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18296 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18297 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18298 redirect addresses.
18302 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18303 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18304 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18305 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18306 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18307 delivery to be deferred.
18309 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18310 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18312 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18313 means of the setting
18317 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18318 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18319 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18321 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18322 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18323 controls what happens next.
18326 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18327 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18328 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18329 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18330 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18331 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18332 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18333 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18335 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18336 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18337 applies to all of them.
18341 .option pass_router routers string unset
18342 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18343 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18344 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18345 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18346 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18347 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18348 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18349 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18350 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18351 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18355 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18356 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18357 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18358 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18359 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18360 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18362 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18363 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18364 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18365 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18369 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18370 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18371 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18372 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18373 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18374 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18375 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18377 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18378 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18379 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18380 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18382 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18383 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18384 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18385 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18386 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18389 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18390 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18393 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18394 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18395 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18396 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18397 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18398 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18399 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18400 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18402 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18403 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18404 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18405 operates as follows:
18407 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18408 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18409 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18410 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18413 require_files = mail:/some/file
18414 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18416 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18417 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18419 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18420 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18421 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18422 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18424 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18425 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18426 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18427 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18428 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18430 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18431 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18432 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18433 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18434 check again in that process.
18436 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18437 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18438 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18439 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18440 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18441 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18442 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18444 require_files = +/some/file
18446 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18447 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18448 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18452 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18453 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18454 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18455 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18456 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18457 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18458 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18459 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18462 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18463 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18464 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18465 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18466 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18469 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18470 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18471 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18475 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18476 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18477 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18479 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18480 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18481 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18482 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18483 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18484 cause the router to defer.
18486 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18487 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18489 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18491 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18492 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18494 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18495 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18496 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18497 of these values that is set:
18500 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18502 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18504 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18506 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18509 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18510 router, but not for the transport.
18514 .option self routers string freeze
18515 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18516 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18517 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18518 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18519 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18520 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18522 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18523 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18524 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18525 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18526 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18528 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18529 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18530 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18531 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18532 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18537 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18539 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18540 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18541 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18542 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18544 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18545 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18546 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18551 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18552 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18553 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18554 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18555 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18556 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18562 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18563 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18564 be passed to the next router.
18567 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18570 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18571 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18572 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18573 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18574 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18575 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18580 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18581 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18582 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18583 address matches something on the list.
18584 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18587 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18588 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18589 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18590 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18591 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18592 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18593 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18597 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18598 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18599 .cindex "packet radio"
18600 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18601 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18602 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18603 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18604 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18605 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18606 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18607 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18609 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18610 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18611 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18612 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18613 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18614 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18615 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18616 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18617 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18618 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18620 translate_ip_address = \
18621 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18624 The file would contain lines like
18626 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18627 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18629 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18634 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18635 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18636 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18637 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18638 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18639 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18640 delivery is deferred.
18642 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18643 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18644 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18648 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18649 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18650 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18651 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18652 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18653 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18654 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18655 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18656 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18657 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18658 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18664 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18665 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18666 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18667 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18668 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18669 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18670 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18671 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18672 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18673 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18675 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18676 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18677 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18678 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18679 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18681 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18687 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18688 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18689 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18690 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18691 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18692 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18693 delivery to be deferred.
18695 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18696 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18697 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18698 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18699 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18700 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18702 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18703 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18704 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18705 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18706 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18707 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18708 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18709 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18711 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18712 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18713 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18714 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18715 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18716 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18717 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18718 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18719 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18720 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18722 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18723 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18724 subsequent routers.
18727 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18728 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18729 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18730 .cindex "transport" "local"
18731 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18732 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18733 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18734 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18735 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18736 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18737 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18738 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18739 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18740 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18741 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18742 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18746 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18747 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18748 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18751 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18752 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18754 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18755 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18756 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18757 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18758 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18759 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18760 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18762 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18763 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18764 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18768 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18769 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18771 delivering in cutthrough mode
18772 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18773 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18775 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18778 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18779 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18780 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18781 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18783 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18784 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18785 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18795 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18796 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18797 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18798 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18799 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18800 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18801 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18802 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18803 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18807 domains = mydomain.example
18809 transport = local_delivery
18811 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18812 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18813 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18814 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18821 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18822 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18824 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18825 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18826 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18827 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18828 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18829 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18831 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18832 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18833 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18834 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18837 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18838 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18839 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18840 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18841 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18842 generic option, the router declines.
18844 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18845 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18846 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18848 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18849 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18850 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18851 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18852 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18853 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18856 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18857 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18858 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18859 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18860 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18861 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18863 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18864 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18865 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18866 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18867 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18868 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18869 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18870 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18871 case routing fails.
18874 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18875 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18876 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18877 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18878 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18880 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18881 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18883 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18885 The domain does not exist in DNS
18887 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18888 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18889 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18891 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18893 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18895 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18896 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18898 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18899 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18901 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18902 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18904 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18905 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18911 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18912 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18913 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18915 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18916 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18917 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18918 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18919 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18920 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18921 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18924 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18925 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18926 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18927 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18928 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18929 required. For example,
18933 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18934 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18935 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18936 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18937 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18940 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18941 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18942 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18943 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18944 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18945 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18947 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18948 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18949 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18950 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18951 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18952 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18953 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18954 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18956 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18957 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18962 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18963 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18964 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18965 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18966 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18967 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18968 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18969 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18973 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
18974 .cindex IPv6 disabling
18975 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
18976 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18977 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18978 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18979 only A records are used.
18981 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
18982 .cindex IPv4 preference
18983 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
18984 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18985 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18986 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18987 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
18989 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18990 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18991 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18992 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18993 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18994 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18995 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18998 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19000 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19001 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19002 the address record.
19005 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19006 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19007 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19008 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19013 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19014 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19015 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19016 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19017 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19018 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19019 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19020 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19021 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19026 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19027 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19028 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19029 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19030 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19031 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19032 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19033 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19034 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19035 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19036 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19038 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19039 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19042 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19043 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19044 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19045 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19046 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19050 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19051 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19052 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19053 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19054 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19055 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19056 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19057 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19059 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19060 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19061 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19062 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19063 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19064 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19065 without processing them independently,
19066 provided the following conditions are met:
19069 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19070 &%headers_remove%&.
19072 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19079 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19080 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19081 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19082 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19083 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19084 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19085 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19086 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19087 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19088 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19090 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19091 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19096 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19097 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19098 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19099 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19104 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19105 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19106 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19107 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19110 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19112 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19113 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19114 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19115 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19116 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19117 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19120 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19121 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19122 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19123 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19124 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19126 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19127 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19128 such as that implied by
19132 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19133 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19134 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19135 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19146 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19148 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19149 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19150 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19151 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19152 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19153 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19154 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19155 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19156 router handles the address
19160 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19161 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19162 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19164 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19166 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19167 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19169 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19170 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19171 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19172 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19174 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19175 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19176 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19177 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19182 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19184 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19185 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19186 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19187 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19188 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19189 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19192 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19194 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19196 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19197 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19198 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19199 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19200 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19201 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19202 must not be specified for it.
19204 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19205 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19206 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19207 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19208 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19209 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19210 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19213 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19214 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19215 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19216 delivery to the address is deferred.
19219 .option port iplookup integer 0
19220 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19221 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19225 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19226 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19227 protocols is to be used.
19230 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19231 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19234 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19236 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19237 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19240 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19241 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19242 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19243 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19244 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19245 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19246 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19247 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19250 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19251 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19252 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19253 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19254 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19255 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19256 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19257 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19258 following could be used:
19260 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19261 reroute = $local_part@$1
19264 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19265 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19266 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19267 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19273 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19275 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19276 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19277 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19278 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19279 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19280 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19281 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19282 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19283 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19284 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19286 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19287 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19288 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19289 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19290 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19291 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19292 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19295 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19296 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19297 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19298 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19299 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19300 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19301 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19304 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19305 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19306 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19307 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19308 below, following the list of private options.
19311 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19313 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19314 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19316 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19317 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19319 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19320 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19321 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19322 of the following values:
19331 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19332 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19333 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19336 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19337 router only if &%more%& is true.
19339 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19340 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19341 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19342 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19344 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19345 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19346 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19349 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19350 .cindex "randomized host list"
19351 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19352 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19353 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19354 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19355 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19356 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19357 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19358 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19360 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19361 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19362 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19363 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19365 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19367 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19368 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19369 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19370 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19371 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19374 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19375 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19376 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19379 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19381 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19382 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19386 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19387 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19388 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19389 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19392 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19393 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19394 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19395 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19396 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19397 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19398 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19399 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19401 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19402 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19403 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19404 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19405 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19406 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19407 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19408 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19413 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19414 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19415 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19416 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19417 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19418 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19420 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19422 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19426 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19427 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19429 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19430 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19431 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19432 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19433 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19434 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19435 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19436 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19437 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19438 in a &%route_list%&).
19440 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19441 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19442 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19443 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19447 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19448 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19449 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19450 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19451 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19452 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19453 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19456 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19457 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19459 This data can be accessed by setting
19461 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19463 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19464 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19465 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19466 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19467 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19472 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19473 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19474 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19475 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19476 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19477 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19478 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19480 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19481 variables are set during its expansion:
19484 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19485 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19486 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19488 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19491 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19493 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19496 .vindex "&$value$&"
19497 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19498 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19500 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19504 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19505 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19509 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19510 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19511 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19512 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19513 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19514 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19517 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19518 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19519 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19521 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19522 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19525 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19526 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19527 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19528 number follows. For example:
19530 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19534 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19535 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19536 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19537 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19538 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19541 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19542 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19543 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19544 records in the DNS. For example:
19546 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19548 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19551 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19553 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19554 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19555 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19556 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19557 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19558 happens is controlled by the
19559 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19560 &%self%& option of the router.
19562 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19563 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19564 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19565 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19566 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19567 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19568 defined by MX preferences.
19570 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19571 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19572 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19574 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19575 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19576 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19577 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19579 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19580 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19583 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19584 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19585 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19587 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19588 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19592 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19593 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19594 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19595 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19596 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19597 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19598 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19601 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19602 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19604 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19605 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19607 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19608 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19609 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19611 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19612 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19613 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19615 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19617 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19622 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19623 domain2 host4:host5
19625 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19626 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19627 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19628 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19631 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19632 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19633 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19634 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19637 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19638 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19643 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19644 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19647 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19648 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19652 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19653 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19654 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19657 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19658 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19659 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19660 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19662 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19664 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19665 your first router something like this:
19668 driver = manualroute
19669 domains = !+local_domains
19670 transport = remote_smtp
19671 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19673 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19674 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19675 they are tried in order
19676 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19677 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19680 driver = manualroute
19681 transport = remote_smtp
19682 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19684 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19685 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19686 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19687 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19688 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19689 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19690 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19691 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19694 .cindex "mail hub example"
19695 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19696 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19697 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19698 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19699 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19700 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19701 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19702 lookup is easier to manage.
19704 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19705 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19709 driver = manualroute
19710 transport = remote_smtp
19711 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19713 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19714 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19715 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19716 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19717 domain can be used to find the host:
19720 driver = manualroute
19721 transport = remote_smtp
19722 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19724 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19725 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19726 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19730 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19731 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19732 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19733 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19734 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19735 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19738 driver = manualroute
19739 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19740 route_list = saved.domain.example
19742 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19743 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19744 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19747 driver = manualroute
19749 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19750 *.saved.domain2.example \
19751 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19754 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19756 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19757 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19758 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19759 the address if the lookup fails.
19762 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19763 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19764 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19765 one way it can be done:
19771 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19772 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19773 return_fail_output = true
19778 driver = manualroute
19780 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19782 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19784 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19786 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19787 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19788 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19790 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19791 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19800 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19801 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19803 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19804 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19805 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19806 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19807 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19808 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19809 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19810 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19811 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19812 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19814 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19816 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19817 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19818 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19819 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19820 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19823 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19824 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19825 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19826 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19827 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19828 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19831 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19832 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19833 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19834 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19835 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19836 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19837 not set, a value for the gid also.
19839 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19840 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19841 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19842 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19843 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19844 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19848 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19849 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19850 before running the command.
19853 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19854 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19855 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19859 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19860 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19861 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19862 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19863 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19866 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19869 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19870 &%no_more%& is set.
19872 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19873 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19874 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19875 included in the SMTP response.
19877 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19878 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19879 included in any SMTP response.
19881 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19883 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19884 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19886 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19887 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19888 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19891 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19892 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19895 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19896 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19898 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19899 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19900 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19901 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19903 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19904 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19905 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19906 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19907 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19909 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19910 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19911 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19912 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19913 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19915 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19916 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19917 variable. For example, this return line
19919 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19921 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19922 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19923 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19924 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19929 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19930 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19932 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19933 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19934 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19935 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19936 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19937 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19938 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19939 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19940 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19941 redirected in several different ways:
19944 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19947 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19949 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19951 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19953 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19955 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19957 It can be discarded.
19960 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19961 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19962 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19963 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19965 If success DSNs have been requested
19966 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19967 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19968 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19972 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19973 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19974 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19975 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19976 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19977 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19981 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19983 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19984 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19985 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19986 cause delivery to be deferred.
19988 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19989 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19994 file = $home/.forward
19997 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19998 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19999 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20000 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20005 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20006 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20007 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20008 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20011 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20012 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20013 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20014 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20016 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20017 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20018 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20019 saves some resources.
20027 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20028 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20029 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20030 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20031 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20034 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20035 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20036 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20037 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20038 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20039 document is intended for use by end users.
20041 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20042 described in the next section.
20045 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20046 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20047 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20048 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20049 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20053 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20054 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20055 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20056 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20057 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20058 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20059 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20060 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20061 commas or newlines.
20062 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20065 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20066 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20067 next newline character is ignored.
20069 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20070 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20071 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20072 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20075 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20076 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20077 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20078 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20079 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20080 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20083 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20087 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20088 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20089 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20090 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20091 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20092 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20093 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20094 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20095 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20096 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20097 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20099 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20100 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20101 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20102 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20103 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20105 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20107 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20108 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20109 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20110 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20111 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20114 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20115 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20116 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20117 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20118 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20120 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20121 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20126 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20127 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20130 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20132 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20133 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20134 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20135 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20136 should really contain
20138 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20140 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20141 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20142 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20146 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20147 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20148 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20151 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20152 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20153 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20154 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20155 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20156 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20157 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20159 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20160 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20161 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20162 in double quotes, for example:
20164 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20166 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20167 quote just the command. An item such as
20169 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20171 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20173 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20174 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20175 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20176 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20177 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20178 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20179 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20180 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20181 an &%accept%& router.
20184 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20185 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20186 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20187 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20189 /home/world/minbari
20191 is treated as a file name, but
20193 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20195 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20196 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20197 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20198 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20200 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20201 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20203 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20204 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20205 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20206 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20209 .cindex "included address list"
20210 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20211 If an item is of the form
20213 :include:<path name>
20215 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20216 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20217 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20218 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20219 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20220 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20222 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20224 It must be given as
20226 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20229 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20230 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20231 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20232 .cindex "black hole"
20233 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20234 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20235 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20236 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20240 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20241 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20242 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20244 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20245 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20246 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20247 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20251 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20252 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20253 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20254 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20255 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20256 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20257 redirection items of the form
20262 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20263 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20264 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20265 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20267 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20269 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20271 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20272 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20274 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20275 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20276 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20278 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20279 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20280 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20281 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20282 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20283 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20284 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20285 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20286 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20289 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20290 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20291 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20292 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20294 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20295 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20296 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20297 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20298 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20300 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20301 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20302 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20303 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20304 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20308 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20309 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20310 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20311 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20312 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20313 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20314 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20318 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20319 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20320 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20321 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20322 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20323 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20324 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20325 aliasing scheme of the type
20327 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20331 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20332 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20333 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20336 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20337 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20339 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20340 the pipes are distinct.
20344 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20345 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20346 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20347 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20348 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20349 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20350 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20351 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20352 can be used to avoid this.
20355 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20356 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20357 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20358 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20359 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20360 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20361 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20365 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20367 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20368 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20371 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20372 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20373 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20376 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20377 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20378 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20379 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20382 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20383 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20384 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20385 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20386 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20387 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20388 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20390 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20391 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20394 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20395 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20396 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20397 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20398 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20402 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20403 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20404 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20405 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20406 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20407 let ordinary users do.
20411 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20412 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20413 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20414 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20415 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20416 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20418 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20419 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20420 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20421 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20422 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20423 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20425 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20427 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20428 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20429 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20430 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20431 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20432 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20433 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20434 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20437 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20438 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20439 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20440 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20441 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20442 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20443 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20444 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20448 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20449 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20450 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20451 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20452 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20453 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20456 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20457 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20458 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20459 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20460 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20461 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20463 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20464 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20465 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20467 data = #Exim filter\n\
20468 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20470 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20471 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20472 choice into a newline.
20475 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20476 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20477 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20478 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20479 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20482 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20483 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20484 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20485 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20486 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20487 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20488 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20489 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20491 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20492 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20493 runs a check on the containing directory,
20494 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20495 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20496 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20497 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20498 not, the router declines.
20501 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20502 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20503 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20504 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20505 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20506 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20507 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20510 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20511 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20512 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20513 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20514 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20517 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20518 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20519 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20520 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20524 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20525 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20526 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20527 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20528 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20533 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20534 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20535 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20536 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20537 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20538 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20539 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20540 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20541 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20542 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20543 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20546 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20547 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20548 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20549 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20550 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20553 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20554 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20555 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20556 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20557 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20558 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20560 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20561 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20562 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20563 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20564 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20565 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20566 &_.forward_& files).
20569 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20570 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20571 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20572 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20573 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20576 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20577 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20578 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20579 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20580 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20581 of the embedded Perl support.
20584 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20585 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20586 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20587 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20588 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20591 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20592 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20593 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20594 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20595 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20598 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20599 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20600 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20601 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20602 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20603 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20604 &%one_time%& is set.
20607 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20608 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20609 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20610 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20611 to make use of &%run%& items.
20614 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20615 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20616 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20617 If this option is true, items of the form
20619 :include:<path name>
20621 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20624 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20625 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20626 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20627 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20628 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20629 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20630 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20633 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20634 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20635 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20636 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20637 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20640 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20641 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20642 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20643 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20644 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20649 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20650 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20651 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20652 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20653 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20654 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20655 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20658 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20660 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20661 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20662 file did not exist.
20665 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20667 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20668 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20669 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20671 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20672 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20673 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20674 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20675 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20676 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20677 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20678 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20682 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20683 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20684 redirection list must start with this directory.
20687 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20688 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20689 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20692 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20693 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20694 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20695 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20696 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20697 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20698 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20699 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20700 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20701 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20702 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20703 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20704 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20705 before they subscribed.
20707 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20708 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20709 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20710 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20713 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20714 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20715 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20716 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20718 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20719 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20720 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20722 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20725 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20726 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20727 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20728 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20729 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20733 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20734 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20735 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20736 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20737 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20738 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20739 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20740 See &%check_owner%& above.
20743 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20744 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20745 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20746 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20749 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20750 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20751 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20752 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20753 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20754 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20755 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20758 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20759 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20760 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20761 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20762 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20763 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20764 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20765 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20767 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20768 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20769 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20772 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20773 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20774 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20775 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20776 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20777 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20778 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20779 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20780 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20781 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20784 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20785 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20786 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20787 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20788 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20789 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20792 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20793 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20794 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20795 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20796 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20797 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20800 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20801 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20802 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20803 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20804 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20807 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20808 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20809 :subaddress part of an address.
20811 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20812 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20813 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20814 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20817 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20818 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20819 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20820 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20821 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20822 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20823 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20827 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20828 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20829 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20830 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20831 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20832 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20833 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20834 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20835 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20836 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20837 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20838 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20839 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20840 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20841 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20842 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20844 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20845 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20846 the following routers.
20848 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20849 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20850 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20851 so it is passed to the following routers.
20853 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20854 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20855 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20856 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20858 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20859 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20860 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20861 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20867 file = $home/.forward
20868 file_transport = address_file
20869 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20870 reply_transport = address_reply
20873 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20874 syntax_errors_text = \
20875 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20876 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20877 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20878 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20879 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20880 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20881 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20882 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20883 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20884 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20886 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20887 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20888 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20893 local_part_prefix = real-
20894 transport = local_delivery
20896 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20897 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20899 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20900 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20904 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20905 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20908 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20909 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20910 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20911 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20921 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20922 "Environment for local transports"
20923 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20924 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20925 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20926 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20927 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20928 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20929 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20931 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20932 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20933 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20934 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20936 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20937 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20938 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20939 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20940 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20944 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20945 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20946 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20947 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20948 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20949 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20950 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20953 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20954 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20958 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20960 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20961 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20962 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20963 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20968 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20969 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20970 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20971 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20972 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20973 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20974 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20975 group (set by the transport). For example:
20978 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20982 transport = group_delivery
20985 # This transport overrides the group
20987 driver = appendfile
20988 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20991 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20992 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20993 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20996 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20997 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20998 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20999 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21000 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21001 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21003 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21004 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21005 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21006 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21007 original gid is also used.
21009 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21010 following that is set is used:
21013 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21015 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21017 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21018 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21020 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21022 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21023 the uid is the creator's uid;
21025 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21028 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21029 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21030 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21031 The first of the following that is set is used:
21034 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21036 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21038 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21040 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21045 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21046 &%never_users%& list.
21052 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21053 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21054 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21055 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21056 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21057 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21058 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21059 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21060 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21061 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21064 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21066 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21068 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21070 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21073 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21076 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21078 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21082 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21083 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21084 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21088 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21089 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21090 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21091 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21092 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21093 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21094 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21095 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21096 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21097 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21098 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21099 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21100 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21101 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21109 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21112 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21113 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21114 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21115 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21116 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21119 .option body_only transports boolean false
21120 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21121 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21122 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21123 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21124 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21125 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21126 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21127 automatically suppress them.
21130 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21131 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21132 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21133 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21134 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21135 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21138 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21139 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21140 deliveries by the transport or for any
21141 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21142 what you are doing.
21145 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21146 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21147 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21148 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21150 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21151 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21152 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21153 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21154 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21155 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21157 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21158 transport and the router that called it.
21160 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21161 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21162 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21163 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21164 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21165 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21166 safely be resent to other recipients.
21169 .option driver transports string unset
21170 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21171 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21174 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21175 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21176 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21177 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21178 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21179 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21180 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21181 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21182 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21183 resent to other recipients.
21186 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21188 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21189 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21192 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21193 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21194 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21195 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21196 &%user%& (see below).
21199 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21200 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21201 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21202 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21203 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21204 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21205 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21206 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21207 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21208 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21209 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21211 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21212 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21215 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21216 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21217 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21218 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21219 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21220 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21221 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21222 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21225 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21226 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21227 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21228 This option specifies a list of header names,
21229 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21230 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21231 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21233 Each list item is separately expanded.
21234 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21235 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21236 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21238 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21239 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21241 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21242 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21243 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21247 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21248 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21249 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21250 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21251 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21252 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21253 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21254 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21257 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21260 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21261 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21262 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21263 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21264 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21265 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21266 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21267 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21268 change envelope recipients at this time.
21271 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21272 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21274 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21275 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21276 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21277 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21278 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21279 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21280 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21284 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21285 .cindex "additional groups"
21286 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21287 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21288 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21289 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21290 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21293 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21294 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21295 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21296 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21297 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21298 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21299 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21300 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21302 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21303 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21304 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21305 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21306 Obviously there is scope for
21307 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21308 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21310 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21311 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21312 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21313 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21314 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21317 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21318 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21319 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21320 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21321 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21322 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21323 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21324 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21325 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21326 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21327 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21328 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21329 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21334 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21335 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21336 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21337 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21338 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21339 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21340 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21341 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21344 local_part_prefix = *-
21346 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21349 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21351 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21352 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21353 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21354 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21355 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21358 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21359 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21360 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21361 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21362 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21363 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21364 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21365 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21366 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21368 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21369 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21370 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21371 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21373 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21374 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21375 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21378 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21379 .cindex "envelope sender"
21380 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21381 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21382 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21383 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21384 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21385 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21386 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21387 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21388 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21390 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21391 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21393 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21394 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21395 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21396 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21397 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21398 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21399 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21401 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21402 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21403 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21404 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21405 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21409 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21410 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21411 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21412 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21413 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21414 have easy access to it.
21416 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21417 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21418 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21419 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21420 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21424 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21425 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21428 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21429 .cindex "shadow transport"
21430 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21431 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21432 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21434 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21435 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21436 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21437 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21438 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21439 cause a log line to be written.
21441 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21442 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21443 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21444 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21445 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21448 ST=<shadow transport name>
21450 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21451 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21452 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21453 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21454 headers that some sites insist on.
21457 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21458 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21459 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21460 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21461 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21462 individual users or via a system filter.
21463 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21465 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21466 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21467 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21468 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21469 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21471 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21472 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21473 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21474 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21475 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21476 &(pipe)& transports.
21478 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21479 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21480 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21481 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21482 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21484 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21485 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21486 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21487 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21489 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21490 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21491 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21492 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21493 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21494 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21496 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21497 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21498 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21499 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21500 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21501 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21502 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21503 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21505 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21506 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21507 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21508 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21509 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21510 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21511 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21512 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21513 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21514 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21517 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21518 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21519 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21520 which the message is being sent. For example:
21522 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21523 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21526 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21527 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21528 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21530 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21531 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21532 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21535 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21537 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21538 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21539 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21540 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21541 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21542 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21544 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21545 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21546 arguments. Consider this example:
21548 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21549 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21551 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21552 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21554 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21555 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21559 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21560 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21561 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21562 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21563 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21564 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21565 bounced from a transport filter.
21567 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21568 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21569 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21572 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21573 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21574 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21575 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21576 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21577 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21578 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21579 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21580 becomes a temporary error.
21583 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21584 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21585 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21586 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21587 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21588 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21589 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21592 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21593 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21594 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21596 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21597 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21598 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21599 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21601 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21602 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21603 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21610 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21611 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21613 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21615 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21616 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21617 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21618 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21619 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21620 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21621 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21623 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21624 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21625 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21626 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21627 local transport, for example:
21630 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21631 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21632 recipients saves space.
21634 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21635 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21637 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21638 to a scanner program or
21639 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21643 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21644 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21645 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21647 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21648 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21649 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21650 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21651 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21652 to certain conditions:
21655 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21656 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21657 batching is possible.
21659 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21660 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21661 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21663 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21664 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21665 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21666 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21667 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21670 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21671 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21672 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21676 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21677 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21678 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21679 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21680 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21681 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21682 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21685 escape_string = ".."
21687 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21688 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21689 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21691 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21692 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21693 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21694 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21695 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21696 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21698 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21699 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21700 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21701 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21702 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21703 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21704 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21705 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21706 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21714 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21715 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21716 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21717 .cindex "directory creation"
21718 .cindex "creating directories"
21719 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21720 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21721 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21722 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21723 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21724 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21725 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21726 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21727 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21728 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21730 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21731 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21732 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21735 .cindex "quota" "system"
21736 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21737 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21738 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21740 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21741 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21742 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21743 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21745 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21746 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21749 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21750 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21751 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21752 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21757 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21758 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21759 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21760 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21761 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21763 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21764 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21765 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21766 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21767 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21768 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21769 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21770 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21771 operation. There are two cases:
21774 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21775 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21776 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21777 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21778 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21779 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21780 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21782 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21783 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21784 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21788 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21789 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21790 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21791 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21796 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21798 require "fileinto";
21799 fileinto "folder23";
21801 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21802 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21803 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21804 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21805 way of handling this requirement:
21807 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21808 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21809 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21811 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21815 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21816 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21817 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21819 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21820 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21821 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21822 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21823 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21824 path to the transport.
21826 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21827 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21832 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21833 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21837 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21838 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21839 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21840 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21841 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21842 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21843 delivery is deferred.
21846 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21847 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21848 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21849 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21850 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21851 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21852 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21853 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21856 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21857 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21858 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21859 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21863 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21864 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21867 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21868 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21869 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21870 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21871 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21874 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21875 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21876 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21877 process is running.
21880 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21881 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21882 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21883 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21884 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21885 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21886 contains is significant.
21888 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21889 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21890 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21891 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21892 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21894 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21895 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21896 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21897 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21898 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21899 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21901 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21902 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21903 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21904 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21906 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21907 .cindex "directory creation"
21908 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21909 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21910 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21912 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21913 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21914 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21915 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21916 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21920 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21921 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21922 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21923 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21924 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21927 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21928 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21929 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21930 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21931 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21932 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21933 &%file_must_exist%&.
21936 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21937 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21938 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21939 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21941 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21942 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21943 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21944 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21945 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21948 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21950 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21951 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21952 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21953 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21955 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21957 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21958 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21962 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21963 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21964 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21967 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21968 See &%check_string%& above.
21971 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21972 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21973 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21974 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21975 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21976 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21979 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21980 .cindex "locking files"
21981 .cindex "lock files"
21982 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21983 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21985 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21986 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21989 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21990 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21993 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21994 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21995 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21996 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21997 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21998 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22002 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22003 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22004 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22005 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22006 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22007 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22008 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22009 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22010 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22013 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22014 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22016 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22017 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22018 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22019 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22020 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22021 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22022 delivery is deferred.
22025 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22026 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22027 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22028 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22031 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22032 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22033 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22034 .cindex "locking files"
22035 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22036 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22037 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22038 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22039 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22040 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22041 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22042 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22044 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22045 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22046 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22047 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22049 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22050 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22053 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22055 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22056 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22057 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22059 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22060 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22062 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22065 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22066 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22067 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22068 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22071 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22072 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22073 for details of locking.
22076 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22077 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22078 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22081 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22082 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22083 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22086 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22087 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22088 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22089 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22090 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22093 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22094 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22095 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22096 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22097 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22098 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22099 external source that maintains the data.
22102 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22103 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22104 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22105 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22106 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22107 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22108 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22109 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22113 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22114 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22115 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22116 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22117 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22118 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22119 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22120 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22121 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22122 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22125 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22126 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22127 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22128 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22129 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22130 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22131 calculation. The default value is:
22133 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22135 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22136 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22138 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22140 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22142 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22143 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22144 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22145 directly into that directory.
22148 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22149 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22150 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22153 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22154 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22155 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22158 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22159 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22160 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22161 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22162 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22163 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22164 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22165 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22167 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22168 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22169 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22170 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22171 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22172 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22173 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22174 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22175 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22176 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22179 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22180 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22181 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22182 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22183 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22184 below for further details.
22187 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22188 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22189 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22192 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22193 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22194 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22197 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22198 .cindex "locking files"
22199 .cindex "file" "locking"
22200 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22201 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22202 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22203 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22204 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22205 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22206 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22208 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22209 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22210 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22217 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22218 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22219 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22220 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22221 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22222 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22223 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22224 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22226 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22227 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22228 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22229 append messages to it.
22232 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22233 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22234 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22235 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22236 in which case it is:
22238 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22239 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22241 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22242 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22244 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22245 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22246 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22247 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22252 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22253 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22255 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22256 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22257 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22258 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22259 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22260 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22261 value, and this option is ignored.
22264 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22265 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22266 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22267 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22268 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22271 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22272 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22273 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22274 on users about incoming mail.
22277 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22278 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22279 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22280 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22281 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22282 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22283 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22284 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22285 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22287 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22288 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22289 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22291 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22292 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22293 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22294 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22295 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22296 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22298 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22299 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22300 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22301 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22302 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22305 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22306 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22308 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22310 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22311 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22312 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22313 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22314 system quota failures.
22316 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22317 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22318 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22319 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22320 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22321 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22322 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22323 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22324 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22325 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22328 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22329 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22330 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22331 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22332 delivery directory.
22335 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22336 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22337 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22338 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22339 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22342 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22343 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22345 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22346 See &%quota%& above.
22349 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22350 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22351 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22352 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22353 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22354 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22355 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22357 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22358 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22359 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22360 the file length to the file name. For example:
22362 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22363 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22365 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22366 number of lines in the message.
22368 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22369 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22370 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22372 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22375 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22376 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22377 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22379 quota_warn_message = "\
22380 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22381 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22382 This message is automatically created \
22383 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22384 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22385 a warning threshold that is\n\
22386 set by the system administrator.\n"
22390 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22391 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22392 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22393 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22394 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22395 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22396 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22397 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22398 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22402 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22404 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22405 percent sign is ignored.
22407 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22408 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22409 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22410 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22411 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22412 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22414 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22416 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22417 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22420 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22421 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22425 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22426 .cindex "envelope sender"
22427 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22428 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22429 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22430 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22431 for details of batch SMTP.
22434 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22435 .cindex "carriage return"
22437 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22438 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22439 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22440 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22442 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22443 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22444 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22445 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22446 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22447 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22450 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22451 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22452 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22453 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22454 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22455 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22458 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22459 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22460 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22461 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22462 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22464 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22465 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22466 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22467 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22469 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22470 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22471 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22472 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22473 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22476 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22477 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22480 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22481 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22482 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22483 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22484 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22485 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22486 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22488 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22489 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22490 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22491 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22494 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22495 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22496 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22499 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22500 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22501 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22502 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22503 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22504 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22505 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22506 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22507 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22509 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22510 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22511 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22512 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22517 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22518 .cindex "appending to a file"
22519 .cindex "file" "appending"
22520 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22523 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22527 .cindex "directory creation"
22528 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22529 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22530 &%directory_mode%& option.
22533 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22534 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22538 .cindex "file" "locking"
22539 .cindex "locking files"
22540 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22541 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22542 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22545 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22546 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22547 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22549 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22551 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22552 Unlink the hitching post name.
22554 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22555 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22556 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22557 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22559 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22560 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22561 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22562 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22563 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22564 it before trying again.
22568 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22569 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22570 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22573 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22574 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22575 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22576 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22577 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22578 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22579 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22580 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22581 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22585 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22586 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22587 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22588 delivery is deferred.
22591 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22592 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22593 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22597 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22598 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22599 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22602 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22603 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22604 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22607 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22608 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22609 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22610 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22611 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22612 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22613 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22614 that prevents link following.
22617 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22618 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22619 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22620 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22621 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22624 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22627 .cindex "file" "locking"
22628 .cindex "locking files"
22629 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22630 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22631 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22632 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22633 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22635 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22637 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22638 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22639 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22641 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22642 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22643 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22645 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22646 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22647 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22648 delivery is deferred.
22650 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22651 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22652 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22653 immediately. It retries up to
22655 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22657 times (rounded up).
22660 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22661 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22664 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22665 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22666 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22667 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22668 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22669 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22670 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22671 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22672 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22673 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22675 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22676 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22677 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22678 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22679 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22680 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22681 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22683 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22684 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22685 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22686 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22689 .cindex "maildir format"
22690 .cindex "mailstore format"
22691 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22692 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22693 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22694 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22695 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22697 .cindex "directory creation"
22698 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22699 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22700 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22701 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22702 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22703 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22708 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22709 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22710 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22711 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22712 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22713 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22714 &_new_& subdirectory.
22716 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22717 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22718 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22719 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22720 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22721 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22722 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22724 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22725 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22726 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22727 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22728 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22729 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22730 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22731 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22733 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22734 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22735 folders. Consider this example:
22737 maildir_format = true
22738 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22739 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22740 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22741 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22743 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22744 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22745 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22746 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22747 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22748 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22750 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22751 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22752 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22753 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22754 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22756 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22757 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22758 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22760 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22761 .cindex "maildir++"
22762 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22763 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22764 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22765 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22766 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22767 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22768 amount of space used.
22770 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22771 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22772 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22773 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22774 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22775 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22780 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22781 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22782 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22783 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22784 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22785 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22788 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22789 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22790 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22791 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22792 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22793 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22794 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22795 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22796 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22797 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22798 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22799 backwards compatibility).
22801 For one common implementation, you might set:
22803 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22805 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22807 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22808 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22809 &[stat()]& each message file.
22812 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22813 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22814 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22815 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22816 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22817 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22818 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22819 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22820 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22822 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22823 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22824 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22825 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22826 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22827 need to know the quota.
22829 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22830 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22832 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22833 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22834 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22838 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22839 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22840 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22841 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22842 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22843 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22844 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22845 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22847 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22848 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22849 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22850 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22851 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22852 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22854 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22855 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22856 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22857 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22858 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22859 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22861 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22862 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22863 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22864 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22867 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22868 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22869 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22870 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22871 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22873 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22875 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22876 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22877 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22878 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22879 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22886 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22889 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22890 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22891 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22892 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22893 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22894 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22895 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22896 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22898 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22899 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22900 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22901 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22902 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22905 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22906 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22907 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22908 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22909 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22911 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22912 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22913 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22914 transport is run as a consequence of a
22916 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22917 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22918 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22919 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22920 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22921 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22923 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22924 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22925 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22926 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22928 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22929 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22930 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22931 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22932 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22933 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22934 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22936 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22937 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22938 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22939 the transport defers.
22940 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22941 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22943 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22944 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22945 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22946 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22948 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22949 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22950 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22951 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22952 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22953 problems. They are just discarded.
22957 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22958 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22960 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22961 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22962 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22965 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22966 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22967 when the message is specified by the transport.
22970 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22971 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22972 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22973 string comes first.
22976 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22977 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22978 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22981 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22982 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22983 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22986 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22987 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22988 specified by the transport.
22991 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22992 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22993 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22994 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22997 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22998 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22999 the message is specified by the transport.
23002 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23003 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23007 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23008 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23009 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23010 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23011 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23015 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23016 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23017 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23018 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23020 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23021 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
23022 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23023 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23024 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23025 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23026 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23029 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23030 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23031 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23032 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23033 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23035 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23036 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23037 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23038 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23039 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23040 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23043 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23044 See &%once%& above.
23047 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23048 See &%once%& above.
23049 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23052 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23053 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23054 specified by the transport.
23057 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23058 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23059 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23060 configuration option.
23063 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23064 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23065 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23066 automatic responses. For example:
23068 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23070 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23071 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23072 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23073 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23078 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23079 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23080 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23081 the text comes first.
23084 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23085 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23086 when the message is specified by the transport.
23087 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23088 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23093 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23096 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23097 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23098 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23099 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23100 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23101 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23103 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23104 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23105 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23106 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23107 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23108 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23112 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23113 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23114 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23117 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23118 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23121 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23122 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23123 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23124 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23125 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23128 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23129 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23130 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23131 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23132 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23133 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23136 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23137 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23138 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23139 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23140 in its response to the LHLO command.
23142 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23143 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23144 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23145 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23148 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23149 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23150 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23151 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23156 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23160 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23161 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23168 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23169 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23170 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23171 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23172 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23173 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23174 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23175 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23179 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23180 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23181 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23182 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23183 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23185 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23186 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23187 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23188 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23189 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23190 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23191 that are routed to the transport.
23193 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23194 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23195 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23196 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23197 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23198 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23199 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23203 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23204 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23205 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23207 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23208 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23209 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23210 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23211 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23212 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23213 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23216 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23217 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23218 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23219 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23220 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23221 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23222 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23227 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23228 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23229 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23230 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23231 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23232 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23233 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23234 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23235 &"local delivery failed"&.
23237 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23238 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23239 will be sent as normal.
23241 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23242 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23243 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23244 apply in this case.
23246 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23247 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23248 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23249 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23251 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23252 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23253 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23254 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23255 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23256 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23257 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23262 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23263 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23264 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23265 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23266 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23269 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23270 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23271 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23272 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23274 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23275 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23276 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23277 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23278 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23280 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23282 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23283 arguments. You have to write
23285 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23287 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23288 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23289 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23290 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23291 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23292 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23295 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23298 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23299 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23300 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23301 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23302 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23303 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23304 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23305 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23306 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23307 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23309 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23310 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23311 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23312 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23313 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23314 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23315 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23316 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23318 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23319 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23320 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23321 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23322 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23323 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23324 control what is done with it.
23326 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23327 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23328 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23329 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23330 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23331 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23332 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23333 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23334 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23335 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23336 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23340 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23341 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23342 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23343 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23344 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23345 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23346 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23347 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23349 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23350 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23351 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23352 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23353 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23354 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23355 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23356 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23357 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23358 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23359 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23360 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23361 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23362 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23363 &`USER `& see below
23365 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23366 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23367 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23368 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23369 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23370 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23371 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23374 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23375 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23376 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23380 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23381 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23382 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23383 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23386 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23387 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23391 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23392 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23393 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23394 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23395 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23396 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23397 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23398 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23399 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23400 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23401 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23404 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23406 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23407 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23408 &%use_shell%& is set.
23411 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23412 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23415 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23416 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23417 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23420 .option check_string pipe string unset
23421 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23422 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23423 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23424 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23425 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23426 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23427 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23431 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23432 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23433 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23434 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23435 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23436 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23437 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23440 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23441 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23442 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23443 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23444 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23445 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23446 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23449 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23450 See &%check_string%& above.
23453 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23454 .cindex "exec failure"
23455 .cindex "failure of exec"
23456 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23457 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23458 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23459 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23460 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23463 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23464 .cindex "signal exit"
23465 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23466 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23467 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23468 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23471 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23472 .cindex "force command"
23473 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23474 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23475 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23476 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23477 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23478 command. For example:
23480 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23484 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23485 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23486 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23489 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23490 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23491 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23492 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23493 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23494 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23496 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23497 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23500 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23501 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23502 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23503 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23504 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23505 written to the main log.
23508 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23509 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23510 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23511 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23512 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23513 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23517 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23518 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23519 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23520 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23521 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23524 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23525 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23526 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23527 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23528 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23529 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23530 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23531 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23534 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23535 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23536 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23539 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23543 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23544 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23545 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23546 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23547 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23552 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23553 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23556 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23557 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23558 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23559 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23563 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23564 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23567 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23568 This option is expanded and
23569 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23570 variable of the subprocess.
23571 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23572 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23573 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23576 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23577 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23578 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23579 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23580 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23581 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23582 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23583 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23584 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23587 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23588 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23589 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23590 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23591 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23592 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23593 accept the message is used.
23596 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23597 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23598 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23599 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23600 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23601 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23604 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23605 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23606 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23607 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23608 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23609 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23610 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23614 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23615 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23616 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23617 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23618 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23619 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23620 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23621 of them may be set.
23625 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23626 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23627 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23628 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23629 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23630 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23631 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23632 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23633 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23634 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23635 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23636 and 73, respectively.
23639 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23640 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23641 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23642 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23643 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23644 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23645 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23647 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23648 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23649 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23650 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23651 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23652 delivery to be deferred.
23654 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23655 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23658 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23659 .cindex "envelope sender"
23660 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23661 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23662 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23663 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23664 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23666 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23667 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23668 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23669 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23670 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23671 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23675 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23676 .cindex "carriage return"
23678 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23679 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23680 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23681 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23683 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23684 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23685 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23686 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23687 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23690 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23691 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23692 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23693 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23694 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23695 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23696 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23697 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23698 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23703 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23704 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23705 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23706 .cindex "external local delivery"
23707 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23708 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23709 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23710 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23711 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23712 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23713 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23714 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23715 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23716 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23721 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23725 check_string = "From "
23726 escape_string = ">From "
23735 transport = procmail_pipe
23737 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23738 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23739 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23740 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23741 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23742 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23744 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23748 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23749 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23752 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23753 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23756 local_delivery_cyrus:
23758 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23759 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23771 local_part_suffix = .*
23772 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23774 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23775 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23777 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23778 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23781 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23782 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23784 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23785 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23786 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23787 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23788 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23789 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23790 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23791 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23794 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23795 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23799 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23800 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23801 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23802 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23803 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23804 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23805 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23807 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23808 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23809 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23810 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23811 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23812 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23817 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23818 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23819 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23823 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23825 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23826 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23827 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23828 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23829 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23830 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23831 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23832 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23835 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23836 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23837 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23838 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23839 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23840 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23841 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23842 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23843 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23844 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23845 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23846 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23847 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23848 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23850 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23851 and will be removed in a future release.
23854 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23855 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23856 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23859 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23860 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23861 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23862 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23863 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23864 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23865 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23866 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23868 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23869 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23870 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23871 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23872 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23873 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23874 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23875 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23876 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23879 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23881 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23882 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23883 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23884 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23885 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23888 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23889 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23890 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23891 particular connection.
23893 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23894 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23895 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23896 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23898 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23899 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23900 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23902 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23904 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23905 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23907 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23908 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23912 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23913 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23914 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23915 authenticated as a client.
23918 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23919 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23920 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23921 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23924 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23925 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23926 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23927 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23928 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23929 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23930 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23933 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23934 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23935 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23936 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23937 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23938 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23939 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23943 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23944 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
23945 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23946 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
23947 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
23948 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
23949 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
23950 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
23951 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
23952 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
23953 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
23954 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
23955 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
23956 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
23959 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23960 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23961 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23962 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23965 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23966 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23967 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23968 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23969 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23970 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23971 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23972 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23973 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23976 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23977 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23978 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23981 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23982 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23983 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23984 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23985 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23986 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23988 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23989 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23990 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23991 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23992 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23993 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23994 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23995 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23999 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24000 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24001 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24002 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24003 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24006 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24007 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24008 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24009 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24013 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24014 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24015 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24016 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24017 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24018 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24019 the dnssec request bit set.
24020 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24024 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24025 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24026 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24027 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24028 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24029 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24030 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24031 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24032 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24036 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24037 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24038 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24039 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24040 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24041 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24042 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24044 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24045 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24046 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24047 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24048 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24051 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24052 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24053 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24054 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24055 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24056 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24057 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24058 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24060 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24061 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24062 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24063 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24064 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24065 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24067 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24068 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24069 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24070 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24071 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24073 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24074 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24075 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24076 copy of the message is sent.
24078 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24079 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24080 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24081 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24085 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24086 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24087 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24090 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24091 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24092 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24093 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24094 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24095 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24097 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24098 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24099 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24100 implementations of TLS.
24102 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24103 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24104 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24105 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24106 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24107 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24108 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24113 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24114 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24115 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24116 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24117 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24118 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24119 interface address, you could use this:
24121 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24122 {$primary_hostname}}
24124 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24127 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24128 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24129 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24130 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24131 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24132 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24134 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24135 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24136 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24137 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24139 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24140 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24141 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24142 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24143 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24144 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24145 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24147 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24148 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24149 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24150 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24151 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24152 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24153 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24156 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24157 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24160 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24161 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24162 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24163 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24164 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24165 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24166 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24167 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24168 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24169 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24172 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24173 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24174 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24175 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24178 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24179 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24180 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24181 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24183 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24184 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24185 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24186 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24187 to any host that matches this list.
24190 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24191 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24192 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24193 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24194 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24195 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24196 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24197 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24200 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24201 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24202 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24207 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24208 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24209 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24210 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24211 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24212 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24213 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24214 explanation of when this might be needed.
24216 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24217 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24218 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24219 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24220 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24221 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24222 message on the same session.
24224 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24225 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24226 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24227 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24228 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24229 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24234 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24235 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24236 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24237 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24238 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24241 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24242 .cindex "randomized host list"
24243 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24244 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24245 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24246 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24247 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24248 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24249 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24250 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24252 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24253 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24254 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24255 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24257 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24259 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24260 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24261 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24263 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24264 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24265 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24266 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24267 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24268 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24269 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24270 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24271 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24274 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24275 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24276 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24277 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24278 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24280 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24281 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24282 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24283 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24284 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24285 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24286 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24287 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24289 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24290 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24291 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24292 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24293 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24295 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24296 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24297 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24298 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24299 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24300 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24302 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24303 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24304 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24305 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24306 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24307 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24308 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24310 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24311 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24312 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24313 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24314 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24315 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24316 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24318 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24319 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24320 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24321 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24322 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24323 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24324 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24325 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24326 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24328 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24329 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24330 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24331 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24332 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24333 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24334 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24335 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24336 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24337 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24339 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24340 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24342 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24343 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24344 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24345 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24346 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24348 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24349 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24350 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24351 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24352 for multi-recipient messages.
24353 The option can usually be left as default.
24355 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24356 .cindex "bind IP address"
24357 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24359 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24360 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24361 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24362 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24363 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24364 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24365 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24366 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24369 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24370 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24371 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24372 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24373 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24374 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24376 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24378 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24379 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24380 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24381 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24384 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24385 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24386 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24387 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24388 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24389 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24390 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24391 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24392 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24393 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24397 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24398 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24399 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24400 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24401 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24403 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24404 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24405 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24406 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24407 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24411 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24412 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24413 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24414 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24415 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24416 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24417 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24418 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24420 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24421 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24422 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24424 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24425 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24426 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24427 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24428 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24429 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24430 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24431 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24433 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24434 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24435 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24436 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24441 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24442 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24443 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24444 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24446 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24447 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24448 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24449 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24450 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24452 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24453 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24454 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24455 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24458 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24459 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24460 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24461 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24462 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24463 addresses is not affected.
24465 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24466 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24467 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24468 Exim to use only the host name.
24469 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24472 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24473 .cindex "serializing connections"
24474 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24475 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24476 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24477 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24478 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24479 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24480 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24482 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24483 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24484 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24485 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24486 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24487 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24489 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24490 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24491 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24492 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24493 are used for ETRN serialization.
24495 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24498 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24499 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24500 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24501 .cindex "size" "of message"
24502 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24503 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24504 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24505 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24506 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24507 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24508 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24509 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24511 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24512 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24515 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24516 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24517 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24518 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24521 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24522 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24523 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24525 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24526 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24527 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24528 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24529 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24532 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24533 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24534 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24535 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24539 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24540 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24541 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24542 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24543 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24546 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24547 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24548 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24549 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24550 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24551 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24554 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24557 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24558 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24560 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24561 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24562 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24563 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24564 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24565 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24566 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24567 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24570 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24571 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24572 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24574 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24575 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24576 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24577 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24578 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24579 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24580 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24581 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24582 ciphers is a preference order.
24586 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24587 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24588 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24589 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24590 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24591 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24592 certificate and private key for the session.
24594 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24596 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24602 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24603 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24604 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24605 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24606 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24607 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24608 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24609 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24610 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24611 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24615 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24616 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24617 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24618 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24619 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24620 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24621 Note that unless the host is in this list
24622 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24623 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24624 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24625 certificate verification succeeds.
24628 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24629 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24630 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24631 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24632 while verifying the server certificate,
24633 checks will be included on the host name
24634 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24635 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24636 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24638 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24641 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24642 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24643 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24645 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24646 The value of this option must be either the
24648 or the absolute path to
24649 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24650 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24652 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24653 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24654 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24657 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24658 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24660 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24662 either by file or directory
24663 are added to those given by the system default location.
24665 The values of &$host$& and
24666 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24667 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24669 For back-compatibility,
24670 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24671 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24672 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24675 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24676 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24677 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24678 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24679 certificate verification must succeed.
24680 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24681 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24682 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24687 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24689 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24690 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24691 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24692 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24693 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24696 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24697 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24698 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24699 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24702 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24703 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24704 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24706 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24707 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24708 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24709 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24710 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24712 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24713 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24714 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24715 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24716 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24717 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24718 see below for an exception).
24720 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24721 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24722 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24723 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24724 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24726 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24727 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24728 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24729 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24730 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24731 reached their retry times.
24733 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24734 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24735 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24736 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24737 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24738 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24739 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24740 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24741 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24742 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24745 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24746 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24747 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24748 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24749 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24750 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24752 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24753 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24754 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24755 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24756 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24757 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24763 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24764 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24766 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24767 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24768 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24769 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24770 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24771 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24773 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24774 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24775 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24776 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24777 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24778 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24779 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24781 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24782 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24783 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24784 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24787 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24788 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24789 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24790 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24792 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24793 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24794 facility; you do not have to use it.
24796 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24797 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24798 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24799 address to which it applies.
24801 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24802 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24803 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24804 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24805 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24806 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24809 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24810 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24811 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24812 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24815 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24816 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24817 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24818 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24819 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24822 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24823 illustrated by these examples:
24826 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24827 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24828 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24829 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24831 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24832 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24837 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24838 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24839 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24840 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24841 message's processing.
24843 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24844 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24845 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24846 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24847 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24848 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24849 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24850 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24851 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24853 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24854 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24855 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24856 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24857 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24858 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24859 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24860 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24861 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24862 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24864 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24865 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24866 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24867 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24868 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24869 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24871 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24872 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24873 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24875 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24876 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24877 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24878 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24879 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24880 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24881 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24882 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24883 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24885 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24886 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24892 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24893 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24894 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24895 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24896 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24897 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24898 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24899 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24900 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24901 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24903 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24905 might produce the output
24907 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24908 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24909 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24910 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24911 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24912 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24913 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24914 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24916 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24917 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24918 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24919 set for a particular transport.
24922 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24923 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24924 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24927 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24929 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24930 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24931 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24932 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24934 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24935 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24936 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24937 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24940 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24941 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24942 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24944 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24945 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24946 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24947 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24948 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24949 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24950 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24952 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24953 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24954 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24955 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24956 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24960 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24961 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24964 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24965 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24966 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24967 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24968 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24969 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24970 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24971 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24972 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24974 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24975 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24976 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24978 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24979 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24980 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24981 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24982 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24983 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24984 of pattern they are set as follows:
24987 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24988 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24989 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24992 *queen@*.fict.example
24994 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24996 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25000 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25001 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25004 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25005 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25006 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25007 rewriting rule of the form
25009 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25011 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25017 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25018 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25019 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25020 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25021 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25025 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25026 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25027 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25028 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25029 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25031 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25033 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25036 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25037 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25038 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25039 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25040 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25041 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25042 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25043 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25044 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25045 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25046 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25047 entry written to the panic log.
25051 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25052 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25055 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25058 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25060 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25063 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25064 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25068 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25070 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25071 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25072 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25073 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25074 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25075 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25077 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25078 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25079 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25080 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25081 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25082 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25083 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25084 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25085 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25086 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25088 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25089 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25090 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25092 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25093 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25096 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25097 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25098 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25099 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25100 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25101 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25102 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25103 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25104 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25106 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25107 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25108 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25109 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25110 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25111 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25112 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25113 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25116 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25117 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25118 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25119 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25122 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25123 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25124 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25126 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25127 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25128 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25129 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25131 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25132 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25133 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25135 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25136 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25137 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25138 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25140 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25144 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25147 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25148 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25149 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25150 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25151 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25152 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25153 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25154 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25156 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25157 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25161 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25162 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25164 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25165 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25166 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25168 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25169 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25170 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25171 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25172 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25173 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25174 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25175 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25177 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25178 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25180 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25182 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25183 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25185 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25186 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25187 messages that originate outside the local host:
25189 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25190 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25192 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25195 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25196 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25197 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25198 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25199 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25200 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25201 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25202 components. For example, the rule
25204 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25206 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25207 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25208 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25209 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25210 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25211 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25212 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25222 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25223 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25224 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25225 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25226 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25227 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25228 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25229 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25230 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25231 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25232 address, domain and error.
25234 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25235 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25236 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25237 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25238 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25239 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25240 log selector is set, the message
25241 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25242 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25243 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25244 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25246 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25247 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25248 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25249 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25250 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25251 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25252 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25253 domain are maintained independently.
25255 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25256 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25257 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25258 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25259 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25260 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25261 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25262 the local address is reached.
25264 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25265 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25266 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25267 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25268 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25270 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25271 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25272 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25273 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25274 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25275 messages that it should now be retaining.
25279 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25280 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25281 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25282 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25283 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25284 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25285 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25286 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25287 message's sender, respectively.
25290 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25291 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25292 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25293 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25294 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25295 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25298 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25300 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25303 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25305 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25306 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25309 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25310 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25311 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25312 expressions work in address lists.
25314 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25315 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25319 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25320 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25321 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25322 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25323 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25324 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25325 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25326 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25327 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25329 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25330 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25331 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25332 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25335 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25336 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25337 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25338 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25339 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25340 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25341 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25342 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25343 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25344 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25349 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25351 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25352 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25353 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25354 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25355 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25356 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25358 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25362 and the retry rules are
25364 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25365 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25367 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25368 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25369 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25370 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25371 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25372 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25374 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25375 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25376 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25377 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25379 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25380 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25381 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25383 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25385 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25386 textual form of the IP address.
25388 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25389 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25390 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25391 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25394 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25395 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25396 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25398 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25399 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25400 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25402 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25403 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25405 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25406 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25409 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25410 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25411 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25412 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25413 retry rule of this form:
25415 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25417 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25418 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25421 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25422 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25423 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25424 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25427 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25428 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25429 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25430 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25431 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25433 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25434 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25436 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25437 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25440 A connection was refused.
25442 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25443 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25445 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25446 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25448 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25449 A connection attempt timed out.
25451 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25452 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25453 obtained from an MX record.
25455 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25456 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25457 obtained from an MX record.
25460 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25462 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25463 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25464 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25465 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25468 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25471 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25472 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25473 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25474 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25475 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25476 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25480 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25481 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25482 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25483 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25484 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25488 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25489 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25490 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25492 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25493 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25494 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25495 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25496 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25497 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25498 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25500 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25501 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25504 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25505 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25506 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25511 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25512 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25513 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25514 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25515 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25518 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25520 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25522 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25524 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25525 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25528 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25530 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25531 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25532 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25533 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25534 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25536 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25537 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25539 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25541 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25542 list is never matched.
25548 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25549 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25550 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25551 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25553 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25555 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25556 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25557 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25558 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25559 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25561 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25562 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25563 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25564 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25565 The available algorithms are:
25568 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25571 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25572 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25573 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25575 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25576 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25577 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25578 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25579 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25580 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25581 queue processing times.
25584 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25585 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25586 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25587 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25588 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25589 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25590 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25591 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25592 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25593 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25594 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25595 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25597 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25598 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25599 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25600 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25601 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25602 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25605 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25606 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25607 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25608 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25609 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25610 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25611 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25612 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25613 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25614 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25615 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25616 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25618 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25619 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25620 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25621 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25622 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25623 deliveries that have been deferred.
25626 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25627 Here are some example retry rules:
25629 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25630 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25631 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25632 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25633 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25634 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25636 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25637 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25638 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25639 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25640 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25641 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25642 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25645 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25646 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25647 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25648 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25649 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25651 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25652 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25653 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25654 were not obtained from an MX record.
25656 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25657 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25658 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25659 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25660 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25664 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25665 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25666 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25667 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25668 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25669 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25670 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25671 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25672 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25673 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25674 failing for the first time.
25676 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25677 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25678 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25679 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25681 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25682 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25683 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25688 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25689 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25690 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25691 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25692 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25693 default retry rule:
25695 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25697 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25698 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25699 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25701 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25702 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25703 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25704 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25705 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25707 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25708 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25709 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25711 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25712 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25713 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25714 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25715 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25716 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25717 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25718 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25720 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25721 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25722 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25723 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25724 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25727 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25728 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25729 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25730 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25731 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25732 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25733 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25734 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25735 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25738 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25739 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25740 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25741 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25742 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25743 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25744 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25745 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25748 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25749 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25750 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25751 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25752 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25753 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25754 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25755 time out the address.
25757 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25758 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25759 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25760 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25761 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25762 considered immediately.
25763 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25764 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25774 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25775 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25776 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25777 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25778 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25779 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25780 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25781 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25782 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25785 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25786 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25789 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25790 the client's EHLO command.
25792 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25793 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25795 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25796 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25797 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25798 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25799 with the AUTH command.
25801 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25803 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25804 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25805 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25808 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25809 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25810 unauthenticated connection.
25813 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25814 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25815 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25816 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25818 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25819 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25820 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25821 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
25822 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25823 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25824 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25825 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25830 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25831 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25832 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25833 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25834 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25835 included by setting
25838 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25841 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25846 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25847 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25848 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25849 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25850 work via a socket interface.
25851 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25852 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25853 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25854 supporting setting a server keytab.
25855 The sixth can be configured to support
25856 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25857 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25858 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25859 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25860 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25862 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25863 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25864 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25865 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25866 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25867 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25868 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25870 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25871 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25872 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25873 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25874 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25875 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25879 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25880 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25882 client_secret = secret2
25884 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25885 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25887 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25888 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25889 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25892 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25893 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25894 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25895 authenticating data.
25897 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25898 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25899 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25900 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25901 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25902 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25903 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25904 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25905 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25906 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25909 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25910 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25911 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25912 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25916 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25917 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25918 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25920 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25921 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25922 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25923 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25924 encrypted by a setting such as:
25926 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25930 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25931 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25932 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25933 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25936 .option driver authenticators string unset
25937 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25938 authenticators is to be used.
25941 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25942 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25943 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25944 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25945 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25946 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25949 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25950 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25951 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25952 mechanism is not advertised.
25953 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25954 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25955 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25958 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25959 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25960 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25963 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25964 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25966 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25967 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25968 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25969 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25970 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25971 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25972 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25973 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25974 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25978 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25979 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25980 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25981 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25982 out the values of variables.
25983 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25984 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25987 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25988 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25989 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25990 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25991 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25992 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25993 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25994 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25995 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25998 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25999 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26000 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26001 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26002 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26003 remembered for later use.
26004 How it is used is described in the following section.
26010 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26011 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26012 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26013 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26014 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26018 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26019 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26021 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26023 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26024 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26025 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26026 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26027 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26028 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26029 given for the MAIL command.
26031 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26032 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26035 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26036 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26037 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26038 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26039 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26040 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26041 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26046 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26047 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26048 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26049 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26051 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26052 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26053 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26054 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26055 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26060 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26061 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26062 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26063 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26067 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26069 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26070 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26073 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26074 the mechanisms are advertised.
26076 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26077 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26078 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26079 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26080 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26081 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26082 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26084 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26086 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26088 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26089 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26090 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26093 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26095 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26096 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26097 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26099 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26100 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26101 command. This is the case if
26104 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26106 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26108 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26109 server authenticators.
26113 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26114 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26115 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26117 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26118 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26119 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26120 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26121 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26122 rejected with a 504 error.
26124 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26125 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26126 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26127 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26128 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26129 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26130 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26131 no successful authentication.
26133 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26134 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26135 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26140 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26141 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26142 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26143 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26144 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26145 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26146 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26150 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26152 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26153 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26154 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26155 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26156 command line to run this script on such data might be
26158 encode '\0user\0password'
26160 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26161 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26162 whose code value is zero.
26164 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26165 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26166 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26167 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26169 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26170 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26171 example, a command such as
26173 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26175 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26177 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26178 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26180 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26182 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26183 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26184 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26185 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26189 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26190 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26191 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26192 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26193 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26194 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26197 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26198 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26199 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26200 of the authenticator.
26203 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26204 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26205 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26206 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26207 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26208 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26209 delivery to be deferred.
26211 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26212 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26213 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26216 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26217 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26218 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26219 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26220 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26221 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26222 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26223 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26224 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26227 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26228 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26229 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26230 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26231 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26232 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26233 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26234 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26236 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26238 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26239 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26240 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26241 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26242 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26243 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26244 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26245 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26246 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26247 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26248 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26249 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26250 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26258 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26260 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26261 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26262 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26263 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26264 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26265 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26266 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26267 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26268 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26269 connections as you do for login accounts.
26271 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26272 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26273 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26275 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26276 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26277 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26279 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26280 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26281 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26284 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26285 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26286 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26287 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26288 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26289 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26290 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26292 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26293 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26294 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26295 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26296 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26297 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26298 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26300 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26301 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26302 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26303 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26305 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26306 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26307 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26309 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26310 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26311 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26312 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26313 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26314 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26315 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26316 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26317 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26318 string as the error text
26320 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26321 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26322 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26326 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26327 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26328 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26329 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26330 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26331 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26332 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26333 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26335 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26336 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26337 configured as follows:
26341 public_name = PLAIN
26343 server_condition = \
26344 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26345 server_set_id = $auth2
26347 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26348 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26349 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26350 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26352 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26353 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26354 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26355 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26359 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26361 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26363 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26364 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26368 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26369 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26371 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26372 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26373 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26374 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26375 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26377 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26378 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26379 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26381 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26382 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26383 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26384 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26385 This is an incorrect example:
26387 server_condition = \
26388 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26390 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26391 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26392 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26393 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26394 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26395 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26396 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26398 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26399 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26401 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26402 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26403 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26404 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26405 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26408 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26409 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26410 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26411 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26412 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26413 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26414 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26418 public_name = LOGIN
26419 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26420 server_condition = \
26421 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26422 server_set_id = $auth1
26424 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26425 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26426 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26427 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26429 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26430 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26431 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26432 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26433 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26437 public_name = LOGIN
26438 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26439 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26442 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26443 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26444 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26445 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26447 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26448 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26449 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26450 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26451 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26452 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26453 uninterpreted string.
26456 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26457 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26458 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26459 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26460 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26466 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26467 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26468 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26470 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26471 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26472 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26473 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26476 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26477 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26478 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26479 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26480 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26481 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26482 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26483 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26484 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26485 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26486 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26487 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26489 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26490 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26492 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26493 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26494 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26495 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26498 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26499 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26503 public_name = PLAIN
26504 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26506 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26507 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26508 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26512 public_name = LOGIN
26513 client_send = : username : mysecret
26515 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26516 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26518 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26519 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26524 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26527 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26528 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26529 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26530 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26531 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26532 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26533 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26534 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26535 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26536 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26537 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26538 available in plain text at either end.
26541 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26542 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26543 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26544 authenticator as a server:
26546 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26547 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26548 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26549 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26550 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26551 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26552 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26553 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26554 returned to the client.
26556 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26557 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26558 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26559 numeric variables for other things.
26561 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26562 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26563 user name, authentication fails.
26567 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26568 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26569 server_set_id = $auth1
26571 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26572 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26573 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26574 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26578 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26579 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26581 server_set_id = $auth1
26583 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26584 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26586 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26587 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26588 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26593 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26594 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26595 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26596 server_set_id = $auth1
26599 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26600 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26601 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26605 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26606 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26607 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26610 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26611 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26612 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26616 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26617 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26618 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26619 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26620 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26621 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26622 send the message to the current server.
26624 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26629 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26631 client_secret = secret
26633 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26634 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26641 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26642 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26643 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26644 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26646 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26647 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26649 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26650 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26651 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26652 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26653 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26655 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26656 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26657 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26658 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26660 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26661 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26662 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26663 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26664 depending on the driver you are using.
26666 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26667 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26668 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26669 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26670 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26673 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26674 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26675 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26676 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26677 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26678 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26679 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26680 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26683 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26684 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26685 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26686 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26687 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26688 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26692 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26693 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26694 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26695 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26698 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26699 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26700 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26701 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26705 driver = cyrus_sasl
26706 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26707 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26708 server_set_id = $auth1
26711 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26712 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26715 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26716 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26719 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26720 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26721 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26722 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26725 driver = cyrus_sasl
26726 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26727 server_set_id = $auth1
26730 driver = cyrus_sasl
26731 public_name = PLAIN
26732 server_set_id = $auth2
26734 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26735 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26736 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26737 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26738 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26745 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26746 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26747 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26748 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26749 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26750 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26751 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26752 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26753 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26755 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26757 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26758 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26759 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26760 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26764 public_name = PLAIN
26765 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26766 server_set_id = $auth1
26771 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26772 server_set_id = $auth1
26774 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26775 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26776 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26777 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26778 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26779 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26780 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26781 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26784 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26785 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26786 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26787 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26788 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26789 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26790 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26791 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26792 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26793 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26794 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26795 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26796 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26797 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26798 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26799 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26800 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26801 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26802 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26803 without code changes in Exim.
26806 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26807 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26808 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26809 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26810 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26813 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26814 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26815 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26817 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26818 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26819 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26821 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26822 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26823 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26826 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26827 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26828 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26829 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26832 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26833 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26834 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26835 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26840 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26841 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26842 server_set_id = $auth1
26846 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26847 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26848 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26849 the password itself.
26851 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26852 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26853 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26854 if available, else the empty string.
26855 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26856 else the empty string.
26858 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26860 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26861 option to be simply "true".
26864 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26865 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26866 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26869 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26870 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26871 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26872 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26875 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26876 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26877 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26878 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26881 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26882 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26883 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26886 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26887 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26888 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26889 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26891 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26892 meanings for these variables:
26895 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26896 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26898 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26899 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26901 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26902 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26905 On a per-mechanism basis:
26908 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26909 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26910 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26912 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26913 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26914 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26916 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26917 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26918 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26919 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26922 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26923 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26924 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26927 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26928 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26930 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26932 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26933 server_realm = imap.example.org
26934 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26935 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26936 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26937 server_condition = yes
26941 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26942 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26944 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26945 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26946 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26947 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26948 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26949 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26950 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26953 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26954 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26955 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26956 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26958 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26959 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26960 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26961 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26963 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26964 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26965 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26969 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26970 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26971 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26972 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26974 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26975 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26976 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26977 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26979 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26981 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26982 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26984 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26985 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26986 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26991 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26992 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26994 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26995 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26996 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26997 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26998 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26999 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27000 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27001 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27002 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27003 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27004 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27005 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
27006 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27010 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27011 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27013 The server sends back a challenge.
27015 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27016 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27019 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27023 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27024 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27025 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27027 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27028 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27029 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27030 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27031 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27032 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27033 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27034 for other things. For example:
27039 server_password = \
27040 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27042 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27043 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27049 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27050 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27051 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27055 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27056 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27059 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27060 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27063 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27064 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27065 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27071 client_username = msn/msn_username
27072 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27073 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27075 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27076 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27083 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27085 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27086 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27087 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27088 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27089 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27090 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27091 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27092 authentication based on client certificates.
27094 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27095 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27096 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27097 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27098 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27099 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27101 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27102 for which it must have been requested via the
27103 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27104 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27106 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27107 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27108 and can authenticate the connection.
27109 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27111 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27114 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27115 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27117 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27118 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27119 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27120 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27121 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27122 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27124 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27125 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27126 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27128 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27135 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27136 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27137 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27139 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27140 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27141 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27143 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27145 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27146 of your configured trust-anchors
27147 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27148 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27149 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27150 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27152 . An alternative might use
27154 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27156 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27157 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27158 . This would help for per-device use.
27160 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27161 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27163 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27164 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27167 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27168 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27169 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27174 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27176 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27177 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27178 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27179 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27180 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27183 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27184 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27185 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27186 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27187 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27188 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27189 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27190 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27191 certificates are used.
27193 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27194 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27195 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27196 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27197 between them is encrypted.
27199 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27200 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27201 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27202 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27205 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27206 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27207 in order to get TLS to work.
27211 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27213 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27214 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27215 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27216 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27217 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27218 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27219 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27220 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27221 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27222 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27223 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27225 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27226 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27227 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27229 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27230 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27231 reassigned for other use.
27232 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27234 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27235 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27236 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27238 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27239 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27240 the most common use is expected to be:
27242 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27244 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27245 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27246 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27247 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27248 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27251 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27252 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27259 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27260 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27261 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27262 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27263 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27267 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27271 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27272 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27274 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27277 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27278 cannot be the path of a directory
27279 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27280 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27282 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27284 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27285 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27286 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27287 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27288 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27290 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27291 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27292 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27293 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27294 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27295 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27296 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27299 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27300 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27302 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27303 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27304 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27305 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27307 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27308 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27310 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27311 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27312 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27313 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27317 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27318 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27319 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27320 but not the chosen filename.
27321 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27322 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27324 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27325 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27326 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27327 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27329 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27330 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27331 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27332 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27333 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27334 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27335 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27337 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27338 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27339 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27340 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27341 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27343 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27344 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27345 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27346 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27347 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27348 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27350 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27351 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27352 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27354 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27355 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27356 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27357 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27360 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27363 # chown exim:exim new-params
27364 # chmod 0600 new-params
27365 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27366 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27367 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27368 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27369 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27370 # chmod 0400 new-params
27371 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27373 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27374 stalling is removed.
27376 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27377 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27378 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27379 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27380 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27381 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27382 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27383 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27384 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27385 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27386 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27388 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27389 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27390 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27391 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27393 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27394 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27395 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27396 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27397 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27400 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27401 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27402 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27403 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27404 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27405 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27406 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27407 directly to this function call.
27408 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27409 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27410 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27411 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27414 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27416 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27417 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27418 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27421 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27422 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27423 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27427 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27430 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27431 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27434 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27435 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27437 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27438 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27441 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27442 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27443 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27444 not be moved to the end of the list.
27447 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27450 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27451 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27454 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27455 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27456 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27457 choice of clients used:
27459 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27460 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27465 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27467 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27471 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27473 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27474 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27475 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27476 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27477 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27478 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27479 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27480 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27481 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27482 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27484 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27485 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27487 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27488 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27489 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27490 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27491 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27492 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27494 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27495 "Priority strings". This is online as
27496 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27497 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27498 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27499 then the example code
27500 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27501 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27505 # Disable older versions of protocols
27506 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27509 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27510 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27511 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27513 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27514 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27515 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27516 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27520 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27526 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27527 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27528 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27529 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27530 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27531 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27532 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27534 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27535 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27537 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27538 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27539 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27542 554 Security failure
27544 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27545 rejected with a 554 error code.
27547 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27548 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27550 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27551 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27552 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27553 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27555 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27557 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27559 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27560 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27562 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27563 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27564 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27565 that goes with it. These files need to be
27566 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27567 always be given as full path names.
27568 The key must not be password-protected.
27569 They can be the same file if both the
27570 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27571 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27572 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27573 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27574 the server's certificate.
27576 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27577 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27578 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27579 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27580 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27581 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27583 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27584 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27585 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27587 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27588 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27589 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27592 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27593 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27594 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27596 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27598 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27599 with the parameters contained in the file.
27600 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27605 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27606 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27607 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27608 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27614 for a way of generating file data.
27616 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27617 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27618 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27619 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27620 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27622 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27623 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27624 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27625 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27626 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27627 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27628 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27629 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27630 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27632 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27633 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27634 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27635 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27636 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27637 documentation for more details.
27639 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27640 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27643 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27644 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27645 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27646 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27647 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27648 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27649 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27650 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27651 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27652 expected certificates.
27653 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27654 an explicit file or,
27655 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27656 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27658 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27661 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27662 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27663 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27665 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27667 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27669 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27670 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27671 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27672 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27673 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27674 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27675 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27676 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27677 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27678 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27680 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27681 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27682 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27683 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27685 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27686 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27687 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27688 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27689 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27690 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27693 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27694 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27695 .cindex "revocation list"
27696 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27697 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27698 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27699 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27700 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27701 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27702 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27704 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27705 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27707 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27708 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27709 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27710 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27711 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27712 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27714 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27715 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27716 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27717 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27719 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27720 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27721 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27722 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27723 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27724 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27725 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27726 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27728 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27729 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27730 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27732 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27733 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27734 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27735 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27736 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27738 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27739 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27740 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27741 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27742 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27745 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27746 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27749 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27750 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27751 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27752 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27753 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27754 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27756 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27757 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27759 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27762 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27763 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27764 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27766 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27767 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27768 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27774 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27775 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27776 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27777 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27778 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27779 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27780 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27781 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27782 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27784 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27785 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27786 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27787 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27788 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27790 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27791 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27792 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27793 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27794 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27797 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27798 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27799 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27800 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27801 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27802 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27803 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27804 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27805 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27806 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27809 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27810 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27811 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27812 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27814 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27815 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27817 the system default set (depending on library version),
27819 or (depending on library version) a directory.
27820 The client verifies the server's certificate
27821 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27822 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27823 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27824 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27826 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27827 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27828 or need not succeed respectively.
27830 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27831 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27832 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27834 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27835 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27836 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27839 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27840 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27841 for OCSP to be relevant.
27844 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27845 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27846 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27847 alternative hosts, if any.
27850 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27851 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27852 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27856 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27857 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27858 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27859 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27860 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27862 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27863 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27864 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27865 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27866 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27867 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27868 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27869 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27870 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27871 outgoing connection.
27875 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27876 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27877 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27878 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27879 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27880 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27881 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27882 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27883 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27884 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27887 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27888 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27891 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27892 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27893 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27894 be of limited use in that environment.
27896 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27897 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27898 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27899 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27900 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27902 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27903 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27904 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27905 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27906 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27908 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27909 received from a client.
27910 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27912 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27913 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27914 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27917 &%tls_certificate%&
27923 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27928 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27929 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27930 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27931 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27932 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27933 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27934 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27936 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27939 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27940 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27941 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27942 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27944 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27945 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27946 built, then you have SNI support).
27950 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27952 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27953 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27954 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27955 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27956 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27957 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27958 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27959 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27960 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27961 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27963 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27964 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27965 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
27966 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27967 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27968 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27969 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27971 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27972 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27973 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27974 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27975 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27976 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27977 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27978 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27979 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27981 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27982 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27983 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27984 information is recorded.
27986 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27987 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27988 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27993 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27994 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27995 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27996 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27997 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27998 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27999 to Apache, currently at
28001 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
28003 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
28004 links to further files.
28005 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28006 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
28007 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
28009 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
28013 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28014 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28015 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28016 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28017 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28018 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28019 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28020 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28021 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28022 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28023 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28024 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28025 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28027 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28028 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28029 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28030 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28034 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28035 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28036 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28037 with OpenSSL, like this:
28038 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28039 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28041 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28044 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28045 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28046 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28047 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28048 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28049 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28050 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28052 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28053 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28054 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28055 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28056 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28057 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28059 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28060 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28061 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28062 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28063 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28064 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28065 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28066 be a sensible resolution).
28068 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28069 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28070 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28072 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28073 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28074 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28075 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28076 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28077 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28079 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28080 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28081 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28082 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
28083 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28084 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28088 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28090 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28091 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28092 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28093 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28094 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28095 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28097 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28098 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28099 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28101 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28102 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28104 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28105 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28106 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28108 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28109 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28110 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28112 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28113 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28115 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28116 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28117 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28118 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28120 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3). The latter specifies
28121 the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server (and should be the sole one transmitted
28122 during the TLS handshake); this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28123 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28124 well-known one. A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate which is used to sign
28125 cerver certificates, but running one securely does require careful arrangement. If a private CA is used
28126 then either all clients must be primed with it, or (probably simpler) the server TLS handshake must transmit
28127 the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate. If a public CA is used then all clients must be primed with it
28128 (losing one advantage of DANE) - but the attack surface is reduced from all public CAs to that single CA.
28129 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28130 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28132 Another approach which should be seriously considered is to use DANE with a certificate
28133 from a public CA, because of another technology, "MTA-STS", described below.
28135 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28137 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28138 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28141 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28142 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28147 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28149 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28151 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28152 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28153 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28156 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28157 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28161 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28162 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28163 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28164 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28165 control the OCSP request.
28167 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28168 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28171 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28172 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28173 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28175 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28177 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28178 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28179 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28180 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28182 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28183 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28184 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28185 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28186 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28187 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28188 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28190 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28194 tls_try_verify_hosts
28195 tls_verify_certificates
28197 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28200 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28201 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28203 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28205 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28207 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28208 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28209 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28210 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28212 .cindex DANE reporting
28213 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28214 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28215 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28216 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28217 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28218 Section 4.3 of that document.
28220 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28222 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28223 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28224 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28225 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28226 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28227 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28228 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28229 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28232 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28233 which is recognized by clients sending to you. That selection is outside your
28236 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28237 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28238 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28239 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28240 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28241 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28242 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28247 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28249 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28250 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28251 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28252 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28253 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28254 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28255 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28256 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28257 one very small ACL:
28261 accept hosts = one.host.only
28263 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28264 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28266 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28267 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28268 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28269 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28270 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28271 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28272 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28273 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28276 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28277 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28278 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28281 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28282 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28283 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28284 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28285 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28286 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28287 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28288 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28289 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28290 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28291 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28292 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28293 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28294 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28295 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28296 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28297 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28298 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28299 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28300 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28303 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28304 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28305 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28306 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28307 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28308 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28309 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28310 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28311 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28312 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28313 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28314 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28315 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28316 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28317 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28318 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28319 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28320 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28321 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28322 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28325 For example, if you set
28327 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28329 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28330 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28331 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28332 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28333 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28334 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28335 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28338 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28339 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28340 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28341 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28342 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28343 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28344 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28345 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28346 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28347 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28348 in any of these ACLs.
28350 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28351 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28352 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28353 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28354 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28355 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28356 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28357 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28359 control = suppress_local_fixups
28361 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28362 run, it is too late.
28364 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28365 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28367 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28368 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28369 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28372 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28373 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28374 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28375 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28376 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28377 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28378 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28379 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28380 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28383 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28384 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28385 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28386 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28387 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28388 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28389 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28390 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28391 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28393 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28394 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28395 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28397 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28398 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28399 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28400 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28404 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28405 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28406 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28407 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28408 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28409 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28410 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28411 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28412 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28413 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28415 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28416 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28417 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28418 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28419 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28420 associated with the DATA command.
28422 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28423 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28424 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28425 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28426 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28427 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28428 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28429 the data specified is received.
28431 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28432 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28433 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28434 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28435 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28438 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28439 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28440 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28441 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28443 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28444 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28445 enabled (which is the default).
28447 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28448 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28449 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28451 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28453 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28456 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28457 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28458 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28460 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28463 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28464 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28465 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28466 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28467 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28468 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28469 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28472 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28473 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28474 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28475 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28476 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28477 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28478 for some or all recipients.
28480 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28481 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28482 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28483 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28484 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28486 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28487 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28488 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28490 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28491 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28493 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28494 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28495 the feature was not requested by the client.
28497 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28498 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28499 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28500 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28501 does not in fact control any access.
28502 For this reason, it may only accept
28503 or warn as its final result.
28505 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28506 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28507 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28508 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28510 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28511 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28513 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28514 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28517 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28518 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28519 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28520 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28521 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28524 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28525 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28526 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28527 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28528 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28529 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28530 situation even worse.
28532 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28533 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28534 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28537 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28538 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28539 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28540 connection. The possible values are:
28542 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28543 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28544 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28545 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28546 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28547 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28548 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28549 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28550 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28551 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28553 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28554 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28555 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28556 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28557 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28561 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28562 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28563 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28564 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28566 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28567 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28569 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28570 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28571 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28572 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28573 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28575 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28576 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28577 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28580 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28581 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28582 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28583 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28584 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28585 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28587 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28588 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28589 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28591 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28592 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28593 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28594 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28596 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28597 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28598 matches the string.
28600 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28601 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28602 want to have something like
28604 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28606 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28607 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28613 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28614 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28615 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28616 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28617 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28618 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28619 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28620 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28621 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28623 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28624 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28625 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28628 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28629 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28630 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28631 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28633 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28634 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28635 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28636 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28637 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28638 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28639 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28641 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28642 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28645 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28646 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28647 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28651 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28652 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28653 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28654 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28655 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28656 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28658 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28659 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28660 used to accept or reject anything.
28662 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28663 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28664 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28665 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28667 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28668 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28669 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28670 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28671 configuration file.
28676 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28677 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28679 .vindex &$local_part$&
28680 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28681 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28682 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28683 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28684 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28685 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28686 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28687 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28688 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28690 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28691 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28692 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28695 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28696 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28697 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28698 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28699 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28702 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28703 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28704 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28705 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28706 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28707 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28708 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28709 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28715 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28716 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28717 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28718 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28719 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28720 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28721 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28722 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28723 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28724 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28725 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28726 unencrypted connections.
28729 accept encrypted = *
28730 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28732 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28734 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28735 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28736 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28737 option to do this.)
28741 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28742 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28743 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28744 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28745 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28746 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28747 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28749 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28750 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28751 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28754 deny dnslists = list1.example
28755 dnslists = list2.example
28757 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28758 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28759 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28760 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28761 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28764 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28765 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28768 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28769 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28770 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28771 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28772 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28773 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28774 check a RCPT command:
28776 accept domains = +local_domains
28780 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28781 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28782 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28783 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28786 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28787 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28788 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28791 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28792 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28793 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28794 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28795 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28796 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28798 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28799 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28801 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28802 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28803 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28805 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28806 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28807 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28812 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28813 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28814 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28815 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28816 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28817 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28818 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28822 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28823 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28824 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28827 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28829 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28833 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28834 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28835 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28836 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28837 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28838 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28839 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28840 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28841 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28843 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28844 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28845 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28849 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28850 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28851 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28853 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28854 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28856 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28857 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28860 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28861 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28862 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28863 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28865 require message = Sender did not verify
28868 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28869 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28870 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28871 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28874 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28875 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28876 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28877 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28878 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28879 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28880 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28882 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28883 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28884 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28885 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28886 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28888 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28889 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28890 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28891 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28892 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28893 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28897 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28898 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28899 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28900 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28902 warn !verify = sender
28903 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28907 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28909 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28910 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28911 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28912 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28913 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28917 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28918 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28919 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28920 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28921 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28922 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28923 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28924 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28925 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28926 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28928 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28929 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28930 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28931 on the same SMTP connection.
28933 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28934 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28935 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28938 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28939 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28940 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28942 accept hosts = whatever
28943 set acl_m4 = some value
28944 accept authenticated = *
28945 set acl_c_auth = yes
28947 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28948 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28949 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28951 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28952 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28953 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28954 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28955 error is generated.
28957 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28958 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28961 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28962 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28963 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28964 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28966 deny domains = *.dom.example
28967 !verify = recipient
28969 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28970 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28971 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28972 two statements are equivalent:
28974 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28975 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28977 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28978 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28980 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28981 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28982 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28984 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28985 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28986 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28987 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28989 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28990 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28991 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28992 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28993 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28994 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28995 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28997 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28998 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28999 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29000 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29001 message is handled.
29003 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29004 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29005 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29006 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29008 require message = Can't verify sender
29010 message = Can't verify recipient
29012 message = This message cannot be used
29014 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29015 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29016 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29017 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29018 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29019 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29021 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29022 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29023 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29024 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29027 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29028 message = Invalid sender from client host
29030 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29031 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29035 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29036 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29037 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29040 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29041 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29042 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29043 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29045 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29046 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29047 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29048 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29049 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29050 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29051 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29052 write rather ugly lines like this:
29054 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29056 Instead, all you need is
29058 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29061 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29062 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29063 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29064 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29065 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29066 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29067 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29068 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29070 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29071 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29072 in several different ways. For example:
29074 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29075 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29076 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29080 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29082 accept ...some conditions
29083 control = queue_only
29085 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29086 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29089 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29091 accept ...some conditions...
29092 control = queue_only
29093 ...some more conditions...
29095 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29096 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29097 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29101 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29102 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29105 warn ...some conditions...
29109 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29110 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29114 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29115 &%require%& verb. For example:
29117 require control = no_multiline_responses
29121 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29122 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29124 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29125 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29126 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29127 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29128 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29129 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29131 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29134 deny ...some conditions...
29137 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29138 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29141 ...some conditions...
29143 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29144 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29146 warn ...some conditions...
29152 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29153 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29154 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29155 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29156 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29157 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29158 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29162 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29163 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29164 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29165 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29166 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29167 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29168 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29171 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29172 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29173 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29174 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29176 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29177 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29179 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29182 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29183 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29185 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29186 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29187 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29190 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29191 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29192 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29193 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29194 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29195 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29198 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29199 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29200 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29203 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29204 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29205 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29206 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29207 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29208 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29210 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29211 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29212 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29213 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29214 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29215 logging rejections.
29218 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29219 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29220 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29221 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29222 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29223 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29224 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29225 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29227 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29228 &` log_reject_target =`&
29230 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29231 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29235 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29236 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29237 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29238 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29239 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29240 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29241 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29244 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29245 &` control = freeze`&
29246 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29248 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29249 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29250 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29253 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29254 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29258 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29259 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29260 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29261 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29262 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29263 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29264 &%accept%& for details.)
29266 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29267 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29268 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29269 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29270 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29272 require message = Host not recognized
29275 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29278 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29279 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29280 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29281 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29282 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29283 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29284 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29285 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29286 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29289 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29290 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29291 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29293 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29294 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29296 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29297 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29298 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29301 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29302 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29304 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29305 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29306 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29309 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29310 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29311 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29313 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29314 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29315 However, the original message is available in the variable
29316 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29317 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29318 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29319 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29321 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29322 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29323 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29324 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29325 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29326 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29330 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29331 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29332 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29333 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29335 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29337 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29338 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29339 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29340 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29343 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29344 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29345 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29346 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29349 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29350 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29351 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29352 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29355 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29356 .cindex "UDP communications"
29357 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29358 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29359 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29360 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29361 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29362 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29363 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29366 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29367 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29374 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29375 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29376 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29379 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29380 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29381 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29382 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29383 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29384 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29385 not work without it. For example:
29387 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29388 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29390 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29391 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29392 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29393 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29394 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29397 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29398 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29399 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29400 .cindex "case of local parts"
29401 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29402 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29403 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29404 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29405 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29406 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29409 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29410 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29411 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29412 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29413 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29415 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29416 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29419 warn control = caseful_local_part
29420 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29422 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29424 control = caselower_local_part
29426 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29427 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29430 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29431 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29432 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29433 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29435 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29436 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29437 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29438 is used for all recipients of the message,
29439 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29440 and data is copied from one to the other.
29442 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29443 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29444 If a recipient-verify callout
29446 connection is subsequently
29447 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29448 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29449 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29451 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29452 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29453 Note also that headers cannot be
29454 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29455 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29456 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29457 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29458 this will affect the timestamp.
29460 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29461 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29462 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29463 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29466 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29467 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29468 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29469 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29473 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29474 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29475 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29476 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29477 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29479 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29481 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29482 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29483 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29484 and does not queue the message.
29485 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29487 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29489 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29492 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29493 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29494 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29495 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29496 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29497 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29498 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29499 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29500 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29502 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29503 with the &'kill'& option.
29504 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29508 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29509 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29510 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29511 control = debug/kill
29515 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29516 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29517 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29518 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29519 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29522 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29523 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29524 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29525 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29526 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29527 strings or to numeric value.
29528 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29529 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29530 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29532 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29533 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29534 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29535 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29536 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29539 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29540 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29541 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29542 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29543 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29544 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29545 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29546 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29548 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29549 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29550 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29551 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29552 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29553 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29557 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29558 .cindex "fake defer"
29559 .cindex "defer, fake"
29560 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29561 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29562 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29563 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29564 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29566 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29567 .cindex "fake rejection"
29568 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29569 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29570 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29571 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29572 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29573 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29574 the same SMTP connection.
29576 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29577 message is supplied, the following is used:
29579 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29580 550-kept for evaluation.
29581 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29582 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29584 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29586 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29587 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29588 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29589 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29590 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29591 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29594 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29595 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29596 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29597 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29599 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29600 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29601 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29602 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29603 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29604 disables such output flushing.
29606 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29607 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29608 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29609 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29610 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29611 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29613 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29614 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29615 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29616 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29617 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29618 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29619 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29620 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29621 to be useful in production.
29623 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29624 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29625 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29626 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29627 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29629 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29630 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29631 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29632 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29633 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29634 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29637 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29638 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29639 verification failed"&) is sent.
29641 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29645 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29646 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29648 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29649 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29650 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29651 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29652 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29653 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29654 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29656 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29657 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29658 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29659 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29660 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29661 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29662 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29663 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29664 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29665 same SMTP connection.
29667 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29668 .cindex "message" "submission"
29669 .cindex "submission mode"
29670 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29671 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29672 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29673 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29674 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29675 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29676 late (the message has already been created).
29678 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29679 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29680 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29681 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29682 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29684 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29685 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29686 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29687 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29688 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29691 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29692 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29694 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29696 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29699 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29700 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29701 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29702 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29705 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29706 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29708 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29709 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29711 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29715 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29716 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29719 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29721 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29722 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29724 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29726 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29731 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29732 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29733 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29734 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29735 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29736 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29738 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29739 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29740 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29742 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29743 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29744 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29745 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29746 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29749 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29750 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29752 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29753 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29754 contains one or more newlines that
29755 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29756 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29757 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29759 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29760 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29761 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29762 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29763 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29764 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29765 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29766 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29767 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29768 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29769 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29771 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29772 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29774 until they are added to the
29775 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29776 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29777 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29778 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29779 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29780 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29781 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29783 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29785 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29786 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29788 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29789 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29791 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29792 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29794 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29795 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29796 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29797 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29800 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29801 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29802 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29803 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29804 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29805 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29806 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29809 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29810 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29811 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29812 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29813 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29815 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29816 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29817 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29818 to be a header name first.) For example:
29820 warn add_header = \
29821 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29823 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29824 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29825 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29826 up in reverse order.
29828 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29829 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29830 system filter or in a router or transport.
29834 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29835 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29836 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29837 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29838 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29839 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29841 warn message = Remove internal headers
29842 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29844 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29845 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29846 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29847 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29848 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29849 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29851 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29852 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29854 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29855 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29856 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29857 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29858 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29860 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29861 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29862 warn message = Remove internal headers
29863 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29865 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29866 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29867 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29868 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29869 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29870 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29871 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29872 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29873 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29874 would have been removed.
29876 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29877 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29878 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29879 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29880 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29881 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29882 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29883 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29884 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29886 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29887 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29889 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29890 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29892 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29893 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29895 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29896 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29897 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29898 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29901 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29902 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29903 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29908 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29909 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29910 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29911 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29912 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29913 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29915 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29916 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29917 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29918 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29919 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29920 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29921 The conditions are as follows:
29925 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29926 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29927 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29928 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29929 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29930 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29931 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29932 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29933 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29934 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29935 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29936 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29938 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29939 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29940 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29941 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29942 The name and values are expanded separately.
29943 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29944 will act as argument separators.
29946 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29947 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29948 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29949 conditions are tested.
29951 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29952 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29953 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29954 for different local users or different local domains.
29956 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29957 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29958 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29959 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29960 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29961 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29962 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29967 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29968 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29969 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29970 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29971 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29972 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29973 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29974 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29975 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29976 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29977 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29978 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29981 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29982 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29983 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29984 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29985 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29986 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29987 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29988 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29990 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29991 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29992 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29993 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29994 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29995 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29996 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29997 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29998 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29999 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30001 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30002 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30003 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30004 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30005 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30006 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30007 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30008 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30009 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30012 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30013 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30016 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30017 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30018 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30019 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30020 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30021 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30022 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30028 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30029 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30030 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30031 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30032 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30033 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30034 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30036 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30038 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30039 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30040 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30042 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30043 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30044 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30045 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30046 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30047 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30049 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30050 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30052 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30053 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30055 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30056 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30057 statement can then check the IP address.
30059 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30060 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30061 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30062 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30064 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30065 message = $host_data
30067 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30069 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30070 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30071 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30072 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30073 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30074 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30075 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30076 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30077 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30078 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30080 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30081 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30082 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30083 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30084 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30085 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30086 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30088 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30089 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30090 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30091 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30092 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30093 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30094 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30097 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30098 .cindex "rate limiting"
30099 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30100 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30102 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30103 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30104 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30105 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30106 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30107 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30109 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30110 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30111 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30112 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30113 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30114 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30115 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30117 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30118 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30119 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30120 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30121 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30122 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30123 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30124 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30125 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30126 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30127 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30128 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30129 influence the sender checking.
30131 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30132 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30134 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30135 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30136 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30137 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30138 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30139 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30143 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30144 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30146 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30147 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30148 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30149 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30150 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30151 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30153 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30154 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30155 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30156 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30157 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30158 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30159 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30160 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30161 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30162 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30164 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30165 .cindex "CSA verification"
30166 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30167 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30168 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30170 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30171 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30172 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30173 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30174 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30175 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30176 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30177 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30178 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30179 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30181 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30182 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30183 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30185 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30186 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30187 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30188 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30189 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30190 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30191 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30192 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30193 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30194 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30195 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30196 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30197 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30198 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30199 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30201 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30202 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30203 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30204 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30207 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30208 !verify = header_sender
30211 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30212 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30213 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30214 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30215 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30216 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30217 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30218 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30219 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30220 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30221 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30222 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30223 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30226 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30227 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30231 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30232 common as they used to be.
30234 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30235 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30236 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30237 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30238 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30239 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30240 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30241 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30242 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30243 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30244 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30245 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30246 independently of this condition.
30248 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30249 option), this condition is always true.
30252 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30253 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30254 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30255 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30256 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30257 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30258 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30259 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30260 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30262 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30263 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30266 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30267 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30268 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30269 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30270 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30271 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30272 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30273 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30274 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30275 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30276 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30277 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30278 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30279 value for the child address.
30281 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30282 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30283 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30284 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30285 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30286 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30287 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30288 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30289 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30290 original IP address.
30292 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30293 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30295 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30296 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30298 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30299 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30300 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30301 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30302 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30303 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30304 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30305 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30306 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30308 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30309 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30310 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30311 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30312 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30313 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30314 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30316 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30317 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30318 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30320 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30321 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30322 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30323 verified as a sender.
30325 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30326 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30327 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30329 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30335 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30336 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30337 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30338 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30339 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30340 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30341 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30342 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30343 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30344 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30346 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30347 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30349 the following records are looked up:
30351 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30352 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30354 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30355 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30356 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30357 use two separate conditions:
30359 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30360 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30362 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30363 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30364 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30367 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30368 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30369 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30370 following special items in the list:
30372 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30373 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30374 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30376 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30377 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30378 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30379 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30381 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30383 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30384 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30386 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30387 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30388 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30390 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30392 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30393 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30394 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30395 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30396 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30397 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30401 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30402 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30403 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30404 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30405 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30407 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30409 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30410 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30411 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30412 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30417 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30418 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30419 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30420 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30421 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30422 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30423 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30425 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30426 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30428 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30429 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30430 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30431 up by this example is
30433 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30435 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30436 addresses. For example:
30438 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30439 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30441 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30442 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30447 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30448 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30449 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30450 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30451 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30452 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30453 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30454 either to double the separators like this:
30456 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30458 or to change the separator character, like this:
30460 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30462 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30463 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30464 occurs. Consider this condition:
30466 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30468 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30470 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30471 a.domain.black.list.tld
30473 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30474 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30475 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30476 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30477 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30478 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30479 error for a previous item.
30481 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30482 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30484 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30485 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30487 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30488 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30490 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30491 $sender_address_domain \
30492 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30494 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30495 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30496 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30498 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30499 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30500 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30501 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30503 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30505 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30506 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30508 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30509 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30514 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30515 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30516 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30517 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30518 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30519 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30523 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30525 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30526 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30527 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30529 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30530 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30531 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30534 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30535 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30536 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30537 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30538 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30539 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30540 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30541 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30542 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30543 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30544 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30545 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30546 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30547 cases, for example:
30549 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30551 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30552 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30553 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30554 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30556 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30558 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30559 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30561 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30562 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30563 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30564 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30565 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30568 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30569 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30570 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30572 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30573 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30575 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30580 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30581 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30582 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30583 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30586 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30588 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30589 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30590 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30591 describes how multiple records are handled.
30593 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30594 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30595 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30597 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30599 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30600 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30601 first. For example:
30603 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30604 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30607 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30608 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30609 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30610 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30611 tested. For example:
30613 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30615 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30616 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30617 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30619 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30621 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30626 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30627 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30630 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30632 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30633 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30635 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30637 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30638 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30639 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30640 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30642 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30643 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30645 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30646 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30648 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30649 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30651 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30652 Consider this example:
30654 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30656 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30659 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30661 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30663 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30664 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30665 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30667 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30672 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30673 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30674 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30675 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30676 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30677 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30679 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30681 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30682 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30683 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30684 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30685 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30686 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30689 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30690 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30691 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30693 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30694 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30697 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30699 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30700 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30702 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30704 for the condition to be true.
30707 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30708 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30710 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30711 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30713 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30715 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30716 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30718 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30719 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30721 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30723 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30724 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30726 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30728 for the condition to be false.
30730 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30731 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30736 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30737 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30738 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30739 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30740 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30741 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30742 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30743 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30744 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30747 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30748 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30749 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30750 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30751 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30752 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30753 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30756 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30757 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30759 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30760 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30762 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30763 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30764 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30765 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30766 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30767 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30769 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30770 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30771 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30774 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30775 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30776 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30777 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30779 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30780 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30781 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30785 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30786 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30787 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30788 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30789 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30790 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30792 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30793 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30795 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30796 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30797 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30799 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30801 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30802 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30804 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30805 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30807 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30808 dnslists = some.list.example
30811 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30812 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30813 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30815 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30818 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30819 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30820 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30821 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30822 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30823 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30824 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30825 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30826 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30827 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30829 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30831 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30832 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30834 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30835 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30836 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30839 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30840 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30841 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30842 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30843 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30844 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30845 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30846 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30847 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30849 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30850 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30851 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30852 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30854 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30855 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30856 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30857 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30858 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30859 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30860 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30861 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30862 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30863 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30865 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30866 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30867 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30870 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30871 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30872 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30873 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30874 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30875 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30877 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30878 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30879 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30880 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30881 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30882 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30883 the &%count=%& option.
30886 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30887 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30888 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30889 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30890 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30892 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30893 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30894 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30895 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30897 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30898 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30899 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30900 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30901 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30902 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30903 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30905 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30906 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30907 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30908 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30909 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30910 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30911 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30913 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30914 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30915 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30916 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30919 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30920 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30921 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30922 multiple different commands.
30924 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30925 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30926 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30927 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30928 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30930 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30933 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30934 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30935 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30936 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30937 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30939 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30940 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30942 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30943 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30944 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30945 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30949 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30950 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30951 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30954 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30955 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30956 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30959 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30960 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30961 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30962 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30963 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30964 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30967 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30968 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30969 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30970 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30971 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30974 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30975 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30976 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30977 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30978 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30979 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30982 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30983 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30984 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
30986 up to the given limit.
30987 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
30988 consists of refusing the message, and
30989 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30990 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
30991 likely not what is wanted.
30994 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30995 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30996 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30997 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30998 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30999 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31000 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31001 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31003 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31007 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31008 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31009 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31010 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31011 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31012 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31013 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31014 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31015 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31017 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31018 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31019 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31020 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31021 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31022 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31024 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31025 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31028 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31029 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31030 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31031 required increases with larger limits.
31033 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31034 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31035 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31036 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31037 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31038 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31039 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31040 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31041 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31045 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31046 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31047 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31048 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31049 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31050 message. For example:
31052 # Log all senders' rates
31053 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31054 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31056 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31057 # at the decimal point.
31058 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31059 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31060 $sender_rate_limit }s
31062 # Keep authenticated users under control
31063 deny authenticated = *
31064 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31066 # System-wide rate limit
31067 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31068 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31070 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31071 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31072 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31073 messages per $sender_rate_period
31074 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31075 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31076 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31078 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31079 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31080 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31081 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31082 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31083 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31084 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31088 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31089 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31090 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31091 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31092 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31093 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31094 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31095 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31096 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31098 verify = sender/callout
31099 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31101 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31102 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31103 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31104 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31105 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31106 The available options are as follows:
31109 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31110 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31111 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31113 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31114 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31115 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31116 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31118 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31119 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31121 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31122 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31123 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31124 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31127 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31128 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31129 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31130 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31131 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31132 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31135 warn !verify = sender
31136 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31138 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31139 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31140 verification failure.
31142 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31143 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31146 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31147 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31149 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31151 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31152 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31153 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31155 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31157 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31160 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31161 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31166 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31167 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31168 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31169 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31170 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31171 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31172 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31173 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31174 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31175 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31176 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31177 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31180 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31181 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31182 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31183 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31184 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31185 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31187 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31188 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31189 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31190 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31191 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31193 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31194 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31195 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31196 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31197 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31198 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31199 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31200 supplies a host list.
31201 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31203 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31204 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31205 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31206 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31207 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31208 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31209 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31211 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31212 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31213 following SMTP commands are sent:
31215 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31217 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31220 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31223 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31226 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31227 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31228 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31229 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31230 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31231 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31233 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31234 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31235 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31236 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31237 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31239 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31240 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31241 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31242 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31243 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31248 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31249 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31250 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31251 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31253 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31255 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31256 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31257 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31261 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31262 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31263 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31266 verify = sender/callout=5s
31268 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31269 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31270 the &%connect%& parameter.
31273 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31274 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31275 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31276 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31278 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31280 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31282 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31283 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31284 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31285 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31286 updated in this circumstance.
31288 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31289 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31290 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31291 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31292 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31293 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31296 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31297 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31298 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31299 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31300 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31301 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31302 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31303 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31304 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31305 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31307 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31309 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31312 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31313 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31314 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31317 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31319 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31320 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31321 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31322 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31323 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31326 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31327 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31328 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31329 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31331 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31332 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31333 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31334 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31335 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31336 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31337 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31338 made, until the cache record expires.
31340 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31341 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31342 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31345 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31347 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31348 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31350 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31352 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31353 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31354 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31355 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31359 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31360 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31361 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31362 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31363 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31365 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31367 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31368 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31369 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31370 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31371 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31373 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31374 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31375 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31377 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31379 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31380 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31381 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31382 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31383 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31385 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31386 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31388 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31390 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31391 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31392 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31393 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31394 usefulness of callout caching.
31397 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31399 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31401 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31402 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31403 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31404 when that is used for the connections.
31405 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31406 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31407 if the use_sender option is used,
31408 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31409 and if no other callouts intervene.
31412 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31413 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31414 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31415 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31416 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31417 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31418 these circumstances.
31420 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31421 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31422 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31423 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31424 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31425 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31426 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31428 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31429 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31430 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31431 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31436 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31437 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31438 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31439 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31440 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31441 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31442 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31443 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31444 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31445 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31447 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31448 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31451 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31452 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31453 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31455 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31456 commands up to and including
31460 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31461 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31462 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31463 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31464 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31465 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31466 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31468 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31469 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31470 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31471 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31472 will eventually be noticed.
31474 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31475 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31476 behaviour will be the same.
31480 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31481 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31482 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31483 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31484 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31485 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31488 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31490 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31491 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31492 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31493 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31494 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31495 550 Sender verification failed
31497 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31498 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31499 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31500 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31503 verify = sender/no_details
31506 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31507 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31508 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31509 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31510 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31511 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31512 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31515 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31516 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31517 verification also fails.
31519 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31520 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31523 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31524 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31525 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31528 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31530 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31531 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31532 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31533 verification to succeed.
31535 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31536 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31537 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31538 option. For example:
31540 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31542 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31543 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31545 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31546 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31547 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31548 address and a report is output for each of them.
31552 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31553 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31554 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31555 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31556 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31557 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31558 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31562 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31563 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31564 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31565 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31566 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31567 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31569 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31570 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31571 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31572 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31575 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31577 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31579 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31580 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31582 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31583 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31586 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31587 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31589 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31591 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31592 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31593 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31594 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31597 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31599 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31600 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31601 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31603 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31604 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31605 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31606 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31607 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31608 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31609 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31610 of legitimate HELO domains.
31612 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31613 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31614 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31615 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31618 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31620 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31621 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31622 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31627 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31628 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31629 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31630 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31631 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31632 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31633 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31634 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31636 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31637 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31638 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31639 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31640 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31641 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31642 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31643 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31645 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31646 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31649 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31650 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31653 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31654 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31657 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31658 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31660 recipients = +batv_senders
31662 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31663 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31665 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31666 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31667 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31669 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31670 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31671 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31672 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31673 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31675 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31676 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31677 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31678 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31679 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31680 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31681 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31683 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31684 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31685 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31686 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31690 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31692 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31693 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31694 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31697 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31700 external_smtp_batv:
31702 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31703 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31704 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31705 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31708 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31712 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31713 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31714 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31715 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31716 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31717 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31718 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31719 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31720 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31721 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31723 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31724 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31725 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31726 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31727 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31728 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31730 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31732 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31733 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31734 system to arbitrary domains.
31737 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31738 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31739 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31740 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31743 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31744 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31745 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31747 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31748 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31750 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31751 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31755 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31757 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31758 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31759 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31761 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31765 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31766 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31768 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31769 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31770 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31771 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31772 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31773 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31774 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31778 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31779 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31780 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31781 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31782 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31790 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31791 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31792 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31793 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31794 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31795 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31798 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31799 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31800 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31801 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31802 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31804 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31805 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31806 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31809 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31810 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31812 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31813 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31814 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31816 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31817 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31819 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31822 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31825 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31826 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31827 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31828 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31829 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31830 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31832 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31833 temporarily created in a file called:
31835 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31837 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31838 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31839 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31840 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31841 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31843 control = no_mbox_unspool
31845 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31846 same directory by default.
31850 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31851 .cindex "virus scanning"
31852 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31853 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31854 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31855 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31856 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31857 in memory and thus are much faster.
31859 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31860 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31862 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31863 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31864 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31865 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31867 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31869 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31871 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31873 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31875 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31876 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
31877 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
31881 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31882 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31883 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
31884 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31885 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31886 This scanner type takes one option,
31887 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31888 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31889 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31890 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31891 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
31892 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
31893 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31895 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
31896 If &`pass_unscanned`&
31897 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
31898 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
31903 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31904 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31905 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31907 If you omit the argument, the default path
31908 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31910 If you use a remote host,
31911 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31912 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31913 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31915 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31921 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
31922 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
31923 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
31925 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31926 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31927 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31928 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31929 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31932 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31937 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31938 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31939 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31940 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31941 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31943 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31944 a UNIX socket specification,
31945 a TCP socket specification,
31946 or a (global) option.
31948 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31949 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31950 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31951 and the second a port number,
31952 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31953 These per-server options are supported:
31955 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31958 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31959 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31961 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31965 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31966 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31967 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31968 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31969 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31971 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31973 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31974 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31975 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31976 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31978 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31979 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31980 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31981 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31982 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31983 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31984 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31985 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31986 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31988 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31989 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31990 (Connection refused)
31993 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31994 contributing the code for this scanner.
31997 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31998 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31999 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32000 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32003 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32004 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32007 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32008 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32009 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32010 the &"trigger"& expression.
32013 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32014 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32015 &"name"& expression.
32018 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32020 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32022 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32023 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32024 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32025 configuration setting:
32027 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32028 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32029 found in file:'(.+)'
32032 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32033 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
32035 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32036 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32037 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32038 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32041 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32042 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32044 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32045 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32048 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32049 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32050 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32054 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32056 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32058 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32059 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32060 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32061 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32064 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32066 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32069 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32070 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
32071 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32073 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32075 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32076 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32078 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32079 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32080 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32081 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32082 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32085 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32087 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32090 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32091 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
32092 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
32093 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
32094 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32095 provided that mksd has
32096 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32098 av_scanner = mksd:2
32100 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32103 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32104 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32105 running on the local machine.
32106 There are four options:
32107 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32108 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32109 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32110 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32111 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32114 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32116 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32117 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32118 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32119 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32120 specify an empty element to get this.
32123 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32124 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32125 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
32126 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32127 client communication. For example:
32129 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32131 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32135 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32136 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32139 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32140 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32141 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32142 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32143 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32144 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32147 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32148 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32149 The first element can then be one of
32152 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32153 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32156 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32157 the condition fails immediately.
32159 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32160 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32161 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32162 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32163 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32166 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32167 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32168 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32170 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32171 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32174 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32176 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32178 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32179 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32180 is set to record the actual address used.
32182 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32183 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32184 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32185 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32188 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32189 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32191 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32193 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32196 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32198 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32199 malware = */defer_ok
32201 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32202 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32204 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32206 in the main Exim configuration.
32208 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32209 set acl_m0 = sophie
32212 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32213 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32218 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32219 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32220 .cindex "spam scanning"
32221 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32223 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32224 score and a report for the message.
32225 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32227 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32228 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32229 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
32231 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32233 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32235 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32236 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32239 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32240 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32241 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32242 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32243 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32244 configuration as follows (example):
32246 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32248 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32249 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32250 iptables firewall, consider setting
32251 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32252 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32253 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32254 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32258 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32260 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32262 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32265 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32266 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32267 file name instead of an address/port pair:
32269 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32271 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32272 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32273 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32274 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32276 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32277 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32280 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32281 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32282 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32285 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32286 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32287 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32289 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32290 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32291 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32292 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32294 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32296 The supported options are:
32298 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32299 weight=<value> Selection bias
32300 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32301 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32302 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32303 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32306 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32307 higher values being tried first.
32308 The default priority is 1.
32310 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32311 Within a priority set
32312 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32313 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32315 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32316 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32317 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32318 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32320 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32321 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32323 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32324 The default value is two minutes.
32326 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32327 a failed connect is made.
32328 The default is to not retry.
32330 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32331 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32332 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32335 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32336 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32337 is set to record the actual address used.
32339 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32340 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32342 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32345 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32346 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32347 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32348 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32349 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32352 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32353 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32354 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32355 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32356 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32358 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32359 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32361 or the use of PRDR,
32362 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32363 are needed to use this feature.
32365 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32366 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32367 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32370 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32371 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32372 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32375 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32376 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32380 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32381 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32382 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32383 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32385 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32386 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32388 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32389 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32390 available for use at delivery time.
32393 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32394 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32395 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32397 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32398 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32399 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32400 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32401 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32403 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32404 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32405 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32406 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32407 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32408 spam bar is 50 characters.
32410 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32411 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32412 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32413 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32414 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32415 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32416 unencoded in headers.
32418 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32419 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32420 spam score versus threshold.
32421 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32425 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32426 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32427 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32429 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32430 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32431 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32432 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32433 spam condition, like this:
32435 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32436 spam = joe/defer_ok
32438 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32440 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32443 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32444 warn spam = nobody:true
32445 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32446 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32448 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32449 # is over threshold
32451 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32453 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32454 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32456 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32461 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32462 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32463 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32464 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32465 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32466 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32467 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32468 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32469 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32470 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32473 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32474 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32475 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32476 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32477 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32478 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32479 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32481 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32482 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32483 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32484 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32485 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32487 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32488 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32489 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32490 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32491 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32494 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32496 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32500 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32502 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32503 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32504 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32505 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32507 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32508 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32509 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32510 the full path and file name.
32512 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32513 filename, and the default path is then used.
32515 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32516 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32517 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32519 decode = $mime_filename
32521 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32522 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32523 automatically unlinked.
32525 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32526 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32527 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32528 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32529 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32531 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32532 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32533 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32535 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32536 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32537 available in the MIME ACL:
32540 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32541 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32542 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32543 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32544 contains the empty string.
32546 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32547 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32548 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32554 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32555 case-insensitively.
32557 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32558 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32559 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32560 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32561 only used for display purposes.
32563 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32564 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32565 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32567 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32568 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32569 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32571 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32572 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32573 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32574 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32575 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32577 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32578 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32579 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32580 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32582 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32583 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32584 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32585 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32589 application/octet-stream
32593 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32596 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32597 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32598 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32599 containing the decoded data.
32604 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32605 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32606 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32607 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32610 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32612 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32614 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32615 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32616 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32617 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32619 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32620 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32624 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32627 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32628 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32631 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32632 and the rest are attachments.
32635 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32638 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32639 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32640 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32642 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32643 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32644 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32645 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32647 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32648 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32649 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32650 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32651 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32653 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32654 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32655 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32656 decoding is fully recursive.
32658 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32659 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32660 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32661 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32662 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32663 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32664 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32669 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32670 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32671 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32672 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32673 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32675 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32676 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32677 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32678 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32679 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32681 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32682 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32683 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32684 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32685 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32686 32K characters are checked.
32688 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32689 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32690 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32691 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32692 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32694 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32695 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32697 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32698 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32699 matching regular expression.
32700 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32701 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32703 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32714 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32715 "Local scan function"
32716 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32717 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32718 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32719 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32720 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32722 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32723 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32724 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32725 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32726 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32728 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32729 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32730 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32731 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32733 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32734 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32735 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32736 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32738 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32739 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32740 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32741 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32742 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32743 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32744 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32745 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32746 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32750 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32751 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32752 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32753 function is before building Exim, by setting
32755 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
32757 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32758 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32759 directory, so you might set
32761 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
32762 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32764 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32765 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32766 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32767 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32768 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32769 _src/local_scan.c_.
32771 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32772 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32774 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32776 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32781 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32782 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32783 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32785 #include "local_scan.h"
32787 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32788 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32789 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32790 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32791 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32792 strings and pointers to character strings:
32794 #define CS (char *)
32795 #define CCS (const char *)
32796 #define CSS (char **)
32797 #define US (unsigned char *)
32798 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32799 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32801 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32803 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32805 The arguments are as follows:
32808 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32809 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32810 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32812 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32813 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32814 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32815 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32816 case this changes in some future version.
32818 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32819 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32822 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32825 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32826 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32827 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32828 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32829 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32830 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32832 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32833 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32834 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32836 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32837 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32838 queued without immediate delivery.
32840 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32841 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32842 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32843 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32844 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32847 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32848 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32849 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32852 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32853 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32854 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32855 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32856 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32857 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32858 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32860 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32861 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32862 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32865 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32866 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32867 &%-oe%& command line options.
32871 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32872 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32873 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32874 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32875 want to do this, you must have the line
32877 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32879 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32880 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32881 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32884 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32885 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32886 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32887 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32888 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32889 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32891 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32892 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32894 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32895 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32896 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32899 int local_scan_options_count =
32900 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32902 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32903 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32907 my_string = some string of text...
32909 The available types of option data are as follows:
32912 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32913 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32914 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32915 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32916 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32917 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32920 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32921 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32922 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32923 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32926 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32927 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32930 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32931 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32932 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32933 printed with the suffix K or M.
32935 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32936 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32937 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32938 always output in octal.
32940 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32941 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32942 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32944 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32945 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32946 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32949 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32950 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32954 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32955 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32956 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32957 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32958 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32959 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32960 C variables are as follows:
32963 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32964 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32965 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32967 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32968 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32969 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32971 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32972 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32973 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32974 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32977 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32978 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32979 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32982 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32983 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32987 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32988 selected, you should use code like this:
32990 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32991 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32993 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32994 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32995 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32997 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32998 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33001 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33002 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33004 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33005 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33007 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33008 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33009 &%-bh%& command line option.
33011 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33012 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33013 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33015 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33016 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33017 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33018 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33020 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33021 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33022 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33024 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33025 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33027 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33028 The number of accepted recipients.
33030 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33031 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33032 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33033 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33034 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33035 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33036 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33037 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33038 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33039 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33040 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33041 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33043 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33044 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33046 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33047 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33048 locally-submitted messages.
33050 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33051 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33052 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33054 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33055 The name of the sending host, if known.
33057 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33058 The port on the sending host.
33060 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33061 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33063 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33064 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33066 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33067 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33068 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33072 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33073 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33074 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33075 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33080 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33081 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33083 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33084 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33085 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33086 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33087 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33088 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33089 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33091 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33092 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33095 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33096 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33097 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33102 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33103 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33106 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33107 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33109 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33110 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33111 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33112 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33114 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33115 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33116 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33117 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33118 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33119 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33120 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33121 is NULL for all recipients.
33126 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33127 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33128 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33129 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33133 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33134 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33136 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33137 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33138 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33139 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33141 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33142 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33143 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33144 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33145 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33147 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33149 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33150 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33151 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33152 return value is as follows:
33157 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33163 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33169 The process timed out.
33173 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33176 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33177 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33178 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33179 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33180 forks a subprocess that is running
33182 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33184 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33185 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33186 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33187 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33189 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33190 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33191 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33192 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33195 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33196 *sender_authentication)*&
33197 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33200 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33202 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33205 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33206 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33207 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33208 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33209 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33211 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33212 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33215 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33216 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33217 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33218 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33219 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33220 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33221 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33222 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33224 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33225 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33226 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33227 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33228 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33229 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33231 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33232 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33233 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33234 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33236 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33237 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33238 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33239 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33240 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33241 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33242 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33243 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33244 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33245 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33247 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33248 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33250 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33251 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33254 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33255 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33256 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33257 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33258 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33261 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33262 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33263 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33264 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33265 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33266 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33268 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33270 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33271 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33272 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33273 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33274 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33277 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33278 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33279 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33280 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33281 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33282 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33283 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33284 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33286 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33287 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33288 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33290 &`OK `& match succeeded
33291 &`FAIL `& match failed
33292 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33294 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33295 inability to contact a database.
33297 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33299 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33300 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33301 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33303 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33305 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33306 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33307 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33309 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33311 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33314 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33316 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33317 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33318 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33319 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33320 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33321 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33324 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33326 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33327 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33328 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33329 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33330 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33331 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33334 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33335 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33336 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33337 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33339 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33340 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33341 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33342 value afterwards. For example:
33344 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33345 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33346 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33349 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33350 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33351 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33352 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33359 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33360 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33361 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33362 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33363 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33364 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33365 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33366 binary string is returned with an error message.
33368 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33369 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33370 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33372 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33373 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33374 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33375 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33376 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33378 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33379 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33380 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33382 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33383 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33384 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33385 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33389 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33390 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33393 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33394 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33395 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33396 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33397 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33398 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33399 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33400 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33403 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33404 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33406 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33407 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33408 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33409 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33410 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33411 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33412 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33414 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33415 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33417 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33418 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33419 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33420 multiple output lines.
33422 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33423 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33424 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33425 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33426 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33427 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33428 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33431 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33432 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33433 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33434 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33436 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33437 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33438 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33440 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33443 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33446 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33447 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33448 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33449 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33450 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33451 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33457 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33458 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33459 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33460 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33461 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33462 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33463 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33466 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33467 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33468 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33469 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33471 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33472 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33474 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33476 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33477 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33478 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33479 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33481 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33482 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33483 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33484 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33491 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33492 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33494 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33495 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33496 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33497 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33498 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33499 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33500 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33501 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33503 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33504 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33505 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33506 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33507 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33509 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33510 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33511 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33512 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33513 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33514 prevent it happening on retries.
33516 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33517 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33518 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33519 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33520 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33521 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33522 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33523 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33526 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33527 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33528 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33529 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33530 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33531 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33532 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33534 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33535 system_filter_user = exim
33537 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33538 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33539 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33540 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33541 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33542 by the &%reply%& command.
33545 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33546 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33547 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33548 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33550 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33551 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33555 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33556 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33557 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33558 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33559 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33560 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33563 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33564 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33565 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33566 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33567 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33568 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33569 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33571 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33572 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33573 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33574 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33575 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33577 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33578 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33579 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33580 to which users' filter files can refer.
33584 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33585 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33586 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33587 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33588 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33592 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33593 .cindex "freezing messages"
33594 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33595 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33596 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33597 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33598 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33599 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33600 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33601 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33602 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33603 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33605 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33607 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33609 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33610 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33611 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33612 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33613 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33616 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33617 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33618 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33619 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33621 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33622 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33623 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33624 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33625 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33626 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33627 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33628 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33629 message. For example:
33631 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33632 because it contains attachments that we are \
33633 not prepared to receive."
33636 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33637 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33638 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33639 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33640 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33641 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33644 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33645 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33647 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33648 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33649 generated by the filter.
33651 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33653 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33654 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33660 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33661 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33666 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33667 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33668 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33669 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33670 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33672 headers add <string>
33673 headers remove <string>
33675 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33676 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33677 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33678 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33679 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33681 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33682 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33683 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33686 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33687 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33690 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33691 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33692 space after input continuations is ignored.
33694 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33695 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33696 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33697 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33698 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33700 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33701 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33702 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33703 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33704 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33705 used for all recipients of the message.
33707 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33708 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33709 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33710 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33711 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33712 until the message is actually being written (see section
33713 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33715 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33716 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33717 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33718 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33719 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33720 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33721 modified more than once.
33723 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33724 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33727 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33728 headers remove "Subject"
33729 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33730 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33735 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33736 .cindex "envelope sender"
33737 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33739 errors_to <some address>
33741 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33742 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33743 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33746 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33748 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33749 address if its delivery failed.
33753 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33754 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33755 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33756 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33757 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33758 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33759 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33760 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33761 which implements such a filter:
33766 domains = +local_domains
33767 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33772 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33773 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33774 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33775 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33777 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33778 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33779 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33780 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33782 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33783 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33784 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33794 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33795 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33796 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33797 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33798 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33799 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33800 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33801 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33803 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33804 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33805 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33806 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33807 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33809 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33810 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33811 loopback interface specially in any way.
33813 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33814 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33819 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33820 .cindex "message" "submission"
33821 .cindex "submission mode"
33822 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33823 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33824 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33825 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33827 control = submission
33829 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33830 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33831 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33832 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33833 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33834 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33836 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33837 control = submission
33839 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33840 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33841 is used to separate options. For example:
33843 control = submission/sender_retain
33845 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33846 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33847 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33848 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33849 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33850 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33851 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33853 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33854 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33857 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33859 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33860 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33861 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33862 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33864 accept authenticated = *
33865 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33866 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33867 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33869 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33870 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33871 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33873 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33875 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33878 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33880 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33881 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33882 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33883 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33885 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33886 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33887 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33888 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33889 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33890 spoof another's address.
33892 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33893 .cindex "line endings"
33894 .cindex "carriage return"
33896 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33897 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33898 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33899 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33900 use CRLF or just CR.
33902 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33903 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33904 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33905 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33906 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33907 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33908 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33909 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33913 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33915 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33918 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33919 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33922 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33923 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33924 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33925 people trying to play silly games.
33927 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33928 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33936 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33937 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33938 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33939 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33940 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33941 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33942 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33943 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33945 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33946 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33947 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33948 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33949 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33951 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33952 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33953 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33954 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33955 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33956 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33957 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33958 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33963 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33964 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33965 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33966 .cindex "sender" "address"
33967 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33968 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33969 .cindex "envelope sender"
33970 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33971 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33972 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33973 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33975 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33976 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33978 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33979 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33980 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33981 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33982 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33983 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33984 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33985 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33986 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33988 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33989 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33990 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33991 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33992 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33993 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33994 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33996 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33997 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33998 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34000 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34001 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34002 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34003 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34007 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34008 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34009 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34010 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34011 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34012 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34013 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34014 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34017 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34018 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34021 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34022 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34026 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34027 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34029 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34030 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34031 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34033 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34036 For a locally-submitted message,
34037 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34038 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34039 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34040 included in log lines in this case.
34042 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34043 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34049 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34050 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34051 includes the header line:
34053 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34056 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34057 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34058 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34059 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34060 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34061 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34064 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34065 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34066 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34067 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34068 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34069 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34071 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34072 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34073 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34074 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34075 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34076 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34077 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34078 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34082 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34083 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34084 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34085 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34086 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34087 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34088 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34089 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34090 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34094 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34095 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34096 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34097 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34098 .cindex "message" "submission"
34099 .cindex "submission mode"
34100 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34101 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34104 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34105 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34107 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34108 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34110 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34111 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34112 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34114 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34115 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34117 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34118 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34122 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34124 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34125 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34126 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34127 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34128 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34129 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34130 &%qualify_domain%&.
34132 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34133 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34134 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34135 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34138 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34139 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34140 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34141 .cindex "message" "submission"
34142 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34143 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34144 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34145 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34146 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34147 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34148 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34149 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34150 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34151 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34154 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34155 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34156 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34157 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34158 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34159 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34161 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34162 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34163 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34164 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34166 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34167 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34168 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34171 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34172 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34173 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34174 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34175 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34176 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34177 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34178 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34179 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34180 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34181 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34182 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34186 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34187 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34188 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34189 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34190 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34191 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34192 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34193 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34194 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34198 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34199 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34200 .cindex "message" "submission"
34201 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34202 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34203 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34204 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34205 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34208 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34209 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34210 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34211 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34212 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34213 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34214 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34215 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34216 line is added to the message.
34218 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34219 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34220 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34221 options true at the same time.
34223 .cindex "submission mode"
34224 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34225 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34226 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34227 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34229 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34230 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34231 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34232 created as follows:
34235 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34236 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34237 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34239 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34240 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34242 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34243 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34246 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34247 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34248 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34249 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34251 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34252 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34253 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34254 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34258 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34259 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34260 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34261 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34262 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34263 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34264 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34265 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34266 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34268 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34269 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34270 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34271 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34272 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34273 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34275 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34276 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34277 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34279 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34280 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34281 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34283 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34284 X-added-second: another added header line
34286 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34288 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34289 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34290 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34292 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34293 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34294 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34295 not part of the names. For example:
34297 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34300 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34301 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34302 Each item is separately expanded.
34303 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34304 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34305 will act as list separators.
34307 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34308 items are expanded at routing time,
34309 and then associated with all addresses that are
34310 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34311 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34312 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34314 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34315 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34316 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34317 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34319 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34320 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34321 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34324 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34325 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34326 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34327 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34328 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34329 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34330 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34332 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34333 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34334 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34335 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34337 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34338 the following consequences:
34341 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34342 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34343 to it, at all times.
34345 Header lines that are added by a router's
34346 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34347 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34349 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34350 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34352 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34353 a later router or by a transport.
34355 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34356 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34358 headers_remove = subject
34359 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34363 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34364 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34370 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34371 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34372 .cindex "constructed address"
34373 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34376 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34380 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34382 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34383 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34384 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34385 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34386 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34387 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34388 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34389 there is no password file entry.
34392 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34393 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34394 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34395 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34396 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34397 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34398 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34399 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34403 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34404 .cindex "case of local parts"
34405 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34406 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34407 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34408 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34409 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34410 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34411 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34414 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34415 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34416 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34417 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34418 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34422 domains = +local_domains
34423 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34424 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34427 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34428 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34429 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34430 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34431 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34435 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34436 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34437 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34438 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34439 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34440 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34441 empty components for compatibility.
34445 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34446 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34447 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34448 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34449 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34450 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34452 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34453 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34454 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34455 example, a header such as
34459 might get rewritten as
34461 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34463 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34464 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34467 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34468 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34469 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34470 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34471 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34472 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34473 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34478 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34480 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34481 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34482 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34483 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34484 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34485 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34486 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34489 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34491 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34493 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34496 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34499 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34501 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34504 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34507 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34508 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34511 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34512 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34513 used to contain the envelope information.
34517 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34518 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34519 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34520 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34521 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34524 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34525 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34526 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34527 processing is the same in both cases.
34529 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34530 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34531 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34532 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34533 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34534 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34535 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34536 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34539 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34540 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34541 required for the transaction.
34543 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34544 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34545 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34546 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34547 is called for verification.
34549 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34550 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34551 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34553 .cindex "carriage return"
34555 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34556 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34557 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34560 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34561 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34562 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34563 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34564 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34565 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34566 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34567 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34568 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34570 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34571 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34572 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34573 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34575 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34576 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34577 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34578 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34580 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34581 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34582 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34583 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34584 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34585 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34586 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34587 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34588 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34589 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34591 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34592 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34594 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34595 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34596 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34597 square bracket of the IP address.
34602 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34603 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34604 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34605 .cindex "host" "error"
34606 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34607 message errors, and recipient errors.
34610 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34611 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34612 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34615 Connection refused or timed out,
34617 Any error response code on connection,
34619 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34621 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34623 I/O errors at any time,
34625 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34626 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34629 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34630 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34631 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34632 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34633 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34634 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34635 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34636 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34638 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34639 .cindex "message" "error"
34640 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34641 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34642 message errors are:
34645 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34648 Timeout after MAIL,
34650 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34651 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34652 connection at any other time.
34655 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34656 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34657 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34658 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34659 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34660 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34661 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34662 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34663 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34664 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34666 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34667 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34668 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34671 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34672 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34673 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34674 recipient errors are:
34677 Any error response to RCPT,
34679 Timeout after RCPT.
34682 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34683 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34684 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34685 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34686 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34687 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34688 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34689 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34690 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34691 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34692 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34693 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34694 the retry clock is reset.
34696 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34697 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34698 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34699 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34700 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34701 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34702 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34703 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34704 recipient's retry time.
34707 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34708 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34709 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34710 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34711 until the next delivery attempt.
34713 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34714 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34715 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34716 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34717 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34720 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34721 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34722 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34723 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34724 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34725 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34726 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34728 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34729 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34730 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34731 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34732 then to be treated as a host error.
34734 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34735 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34736 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34737 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34738 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34743 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34744 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34745 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34748 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34749 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34750 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34752 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34754 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34755 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34756 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34757 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34758 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34759 stream and exits with an error code.
34761 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34762 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34763 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34764 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34766 .cindex "carriage return"
34768 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34769 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34770 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34772 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34773 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34774 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34776 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34777 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34778 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34779 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34780 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34781 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34782 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34783 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34785 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34786 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34787 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34788 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34789 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34790 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34791 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34792 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34793 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34795 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34796 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34797 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34799 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34800 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34801 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34802 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34803 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34805 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34806 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34807 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34808 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34809 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34810 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34811 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34813 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34814 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34815 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34816 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34817 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34819 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34820 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34821 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34822 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34823 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34824 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34825 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34826 a delivery process.
34828 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34829 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34830 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34831 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34832 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34834 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34835 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34836 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34837 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34839 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34840 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34841 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34845 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34846 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34847 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34848 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34849 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34850 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34851 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34852 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34855 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34856 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34857 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34858 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34859 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34860 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34861 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34862 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34863 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34864 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34865 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34869 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34870 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34871 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34872 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34873 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34874 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34875 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34876 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34878 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34879 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34880 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34881 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34882 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34885 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34886 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34887 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34889 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34890 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34891 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34892 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34893 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34898 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34899 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34900 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34901 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34903 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34904 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34905 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34906 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34907 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34908 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34909 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34910 SMTP response codes.
34912 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34913 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34914 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34915 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34916 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34917 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34918 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34919 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34924 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34925 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34926 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34927 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34928 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34929 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34930 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34932 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34933 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34934 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34935 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34936 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34937 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34938 argument. For example,
34946 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34947 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34948 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34949 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34950 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34952 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34953 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34954 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34955 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34956 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34957 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34958 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34959 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34961 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34962 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34963 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34964 whatever the form of its argument. For
34967 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34968 $sender_host_address
34970 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34971 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34972 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34973 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34974 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34975 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34976 for it to change them before running the command.
34980 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34981 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34982 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34983 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34984 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34985 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34986 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34987 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34988 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34989 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34990 runs for RCPT commands:
34994 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34998 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34999 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35000 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35001 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35002 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35003 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35004 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35005 envelope along with the message.
35007 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35008 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35009 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35010 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35011 can be used to specify it.
35013 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35014 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35015 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35016 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35017 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35020 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35021 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35022 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35027 driver = manualroute
35028 transport = smtp_appendfile
35029 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35033 driver = appendfile
35034 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35039 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35040 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35041 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35045 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35046 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35047 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35048 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35049 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35050 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35051 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35052 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35053 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35054 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35056 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35057 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35059 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35060 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35061 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35062 make some use of automatically, for example:
35064 554 Unexpected end of file
35065 Transaction started in line 10
35066 Error detected in line 14
35068 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35071 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35072 The error message was:
35074 501 '>' missing at end of address
35076 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35077 The error was detected in line 12.
35078 The SMTP command at fault was:
35080 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35082 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35083 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35085 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35086 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35088 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35089 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35093 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35096 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35097 "Customizing messages"
35098 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35099 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35100 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35101 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35102 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35104 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35105 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35106 option. Exim also adds the line
35108 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35110 to all warning and bounce messages,
35113 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35114 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35115 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35116 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35117 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35118 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35119 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35121 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35122 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35123 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35124 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35125 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35128 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35129 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35130 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35131 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35132 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35133 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35134 option, rounded to a whole number.
35136 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35139 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35140 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35142 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35143 failing addresses with their error messages.
35145 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35146 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35148 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35149 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35152 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35153 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35154 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35156 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35157 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35158 {: returning message to sender}}
35160 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35162 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35163 {that you sent }{sent by
35167 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35168 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35170 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35172 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35175 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35177 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35180 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35181 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35182 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35183 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35184 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35188 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35189 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35191 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35192 the delayed addresses.
35194 The third item then ends the message.
35197 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35198 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35200 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35201 $warn_message_delay
35203 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35205 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35206 {that you sent }{sent by
35210 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35211 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35213 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35214 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35215 The date of the message is: $h_date
35217 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35219 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35220 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35221 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35222 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35223 the message will be returned to you.
35225 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35226 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35227 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35228 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35229 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35230 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35231 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35232 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35238 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35239 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35241 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35242 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35243 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35247 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35248 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35249 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35250 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35251 routing explicitly:
35253 send_to_smart_host:
35254 driver = manualroute
35255 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35256 transport = remote_smtp
35258 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35259 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35260 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35261 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35262 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35267 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35268 .cindex "mailing lists"
35269 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35270 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35271 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35273 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35274 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35275 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35276 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35280 domains = lists.example
35281 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35284 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35287 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35288 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35289 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35290 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35292 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35293 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35296 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35297 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35298 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35299 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35300 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35302 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35303 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35304 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35305 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35306 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35307 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35308 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35309 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35310 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35314 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35315 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35316 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35317 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35318 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35319 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35320 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35322 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35323 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35324 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35325 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35326 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35330 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35331 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35332 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35333 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35334 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35335 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35336 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35337 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35338 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35339 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35341 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35342 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35343 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35344 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35345 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35346 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35347 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35348 pre-existing messages.
35350 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35351 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35352 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35353 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35354 one level of expansion anyway.
35358 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35359 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35360 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35361 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35362 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35363 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35365 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35366 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35370 domains = lists.example
35371 local_part_suffix = -request
35372 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35377 domains = lists.example
35378 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35379 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35380 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35383 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35388 domains = lists.example
35390 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35392 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35393 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35394 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35397 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35398 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35399 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35400 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35401 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35402 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35403 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35404 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35405 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35407 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35408 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35409 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35414 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35416 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35417 .cindex "envelope sender"
35418 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35419 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35420 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35421 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35422 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35423 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35425 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35426 .oindex &%return_path%&
35427 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35428 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35429 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35430 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35431 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35432 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35433 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35439 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35440 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35442 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35443 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35444 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35445 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35446 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35447 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35448 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35451 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35453 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35454 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35455 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35456 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35457 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35458 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35460 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35461 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35462 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35463 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35467 domains = ! +local_domains
35469 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35470 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35473 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35474 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35475 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35476 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35479 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35480 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35481 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35482 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35483 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35487 domains = ! +local_domains
35488 transport = remote_smtp
35490 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35491 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35494 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35495 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35496 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35497 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35500 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35501 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35502 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35503 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35504 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35505 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35513 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35514 .cindex "virtual domains"
35515 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35516 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35520 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35521 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35522 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35524 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35525 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35526 have login accounts on that host.
35529 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35530 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35531 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35532 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35533 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35534 to a router of this form:
35538 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35539 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35542 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35543 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35544 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35545 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35546 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35547 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35549 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35550 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35551 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35552 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35554 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35555 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35556 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35560 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35561 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35562 transport = my_mailboxes
35564 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35565 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35566 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35567 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35568 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35572 driver = appendfile
35573 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35576 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35577 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35579 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35580 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35581 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35582 information about the domains.
35586 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35587 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35588 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35589 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35590 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35591 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35592 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35593 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35594 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35595 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35596 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35597 example, consider this router:
35602 file = $home/.forward
35603 local_part_suffix = -*
35604 local_part_suffix_optional
35607 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35608 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35609 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35610 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35612 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35613 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35616 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35617 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35618 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35619 control over which suffixes are valid.
35621 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35622 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35628 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35629 local_part_suffix = -*
35630 local_part_suffix_optional
35633 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35634 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35635 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35636 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35637 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35641 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35642 .cindex "vacation processing"
35643 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35644 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35645 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35646 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35647 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35650 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35651 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35652 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35653 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35655 spqr, vacation-spqr
35658 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35659 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35660 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35661 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35662 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35666 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35667 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35671 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35672 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35673 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35674 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35675 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35676 each day's messages.
35678 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35679 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35680 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35681 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35685 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35686 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35687 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35688 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35689 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35690 permanently connected.
35692 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35693 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35694 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35697 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35698 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35699 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35700 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35701 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35702 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35703 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35704 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35706 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35707 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35708 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35709 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35710 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35711 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35714 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35715 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35716 intermittent host. For example:
35718 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35720 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35721 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35722 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35723 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35724 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35725 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35728 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35729 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35730 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35731 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35732 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35733 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35734 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35738 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35739 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35740 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35741 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35742 delivered immediately.
35744 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35745 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35746 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35747 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35748 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35749 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35750 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35751 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35752 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35753 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35754 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35755 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35756 single SMTP connection.
35760 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35763 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35764 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35765 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35766 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35767 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35768 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35769 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35770 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35771 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35772 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35775 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35776 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35777 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35778 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35779 email is not desirable.
35781 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35782 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35783 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35784 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35785 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35786 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35787 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35789 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35790 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35791 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35792 before sending a message to the smart host.
35794 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35795 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35796 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35798 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35799 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35800 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35801 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35802 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35803 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35804 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35806 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35810 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35811 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35813 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35814 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35815 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35816 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35817 successful, a zero return code is given.
35819 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35820 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35821 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35822 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35823 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35826 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35827 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35828 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35830 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35831 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35832 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35833 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35834 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35836 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35837 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35838 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35840 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35841 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35842 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35843 are ever generated.
35845 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35847 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35848 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35849 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35852 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35853 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35854 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35855 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35856 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35857 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35865 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35866 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35867 .cindex "log" "types of"
35868 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35873 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35874 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35875 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35876 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35877 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35878 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35879 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35880 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35882 .cindex "reject log"
35883 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35884 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35885 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35886 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35887 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35888 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35889 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35890 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35891 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35894 .cindex "panic log"
35895 .cindex "system log"
35896 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35897 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35898 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35899 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35900 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35901 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35902 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35903 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35904 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35907 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35908 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35909 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35911 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35914 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35915 ways of changing this:
35918 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35923 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35925 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35928 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35932 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35933 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35934 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35935 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35936 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35937 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35942 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35943 .cindex "log" "destination"
35944 .cindex "log" "to file"
35945 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35947 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35948 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35949 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35950 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35951 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35952 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35953 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35955 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35956 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35957 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35958 references to the host name:
35960 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35962 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35963 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35964 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35965 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35966 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35969 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35970 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35971 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35972 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35973 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35974 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35975 implying the use of a default path.
35977 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35978 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35979 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35980 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35981 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35982 equivalent to the setting:
35984 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35986 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35987 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35988 that is where the logs are written.
35990 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35991 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35993 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35995 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35996 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35997 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35998 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36000 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36005 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36006 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36007 .cindex "cycling logs"
36008 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36009 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36010 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36011 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36012 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36013 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36014 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36016 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36017 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36018 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36019 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36020 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36021 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36022 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36023 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36024 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36025 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36026 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36031 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36032 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36033 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36034 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36035 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36036 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36037 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36038 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36040 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36041 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36042 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36043 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36045 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36046 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36048 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36049 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36050 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36051 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36053 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36054 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36055 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36056 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36058 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36059 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36060 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36061 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36062 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36063 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36066 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36067 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36068 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36069 /var/log/exim/panic
36073 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36074 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36075 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36076 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36077 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36078 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36079 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36080 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36081 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36082 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36083 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36084 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36085 the time and host name to each line.
36086 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36089 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36091 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36093 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36096 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36097 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36098 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36099 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36101 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36102 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36103 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36104 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36105 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36106 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36107 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36108 RFC 3164, you should set
36110 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36112 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36113 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36115 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36116 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36117 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36118 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36119 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36120 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36121 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36122 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36123 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36125 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36126 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36127 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36128 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36131 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36134 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36135 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36136 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36137 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36139 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36140 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36141 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36142 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36143 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36144 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36146 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36147 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36148 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36151 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36153 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36154 without modification.
36156 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36157 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36158 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36163 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36164 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36165 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36166 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36167 timestamp. The flags are:
36169 &`<=`& message arrival
36170 &`(=`& message fakereject
36171 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36172 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36173 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36174 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36175 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36176 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36180 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36181 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36182 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36183 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36184 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36186 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36187 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36188 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36190 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36191 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36192 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36196 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36200 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36201 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36202 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36203 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36204 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36205 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36206 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36207 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36208 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36209 name in parentheses.
36211 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36212 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36213 the log containing text like these examples:
36215 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36216 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36218 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36221 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36222 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36225 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36226 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36227 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36228 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36229 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36230 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36231 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36232 suite that was used.
36234 .cindex log protocol
36235 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36236 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36237 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36238 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36239 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36240 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36241 authenticator name.
36243 .cindex "size" "of message"
36244 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36245 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36246 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36247 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36250 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36251 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36255 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36256 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36257 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36258 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36259 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36260 to fit it on the page:
36262 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36263 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36264 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36265 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36266 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36268 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36269 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36270 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36271 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36272 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36274 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36275 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36276 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36277 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36279 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36280 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36282 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36284 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36285 parentheses afterwards.
36287 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36288 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36289 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36290 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36291 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36292 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36293 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36294 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36295 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36296 TLS cipher information is still available.
36298 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36299 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36300 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36301 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36302 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36304 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36305 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36307 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36308 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36311 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36312 .cindex "discarded messages"
36313 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36314 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36315 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36316 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36318 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36319 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36321 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36322 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36324 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36325 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36329 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36330 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36332 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36333 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36335 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36336 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36337 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36339 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36340 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36342 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36343 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36344 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36348 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36349 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36350 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36351 following form is logged:
36353 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36354 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36356 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36357 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36359 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36360 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36361 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36362 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36363 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36365 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36366 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36367 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36368 flagged with &`**`&.
36372 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36373 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36374 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36375 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36376 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36380 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36383 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36385 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36386 at the end of its processing.
36391 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36392 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36393 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36394 the following table:
36396 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36397 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36398 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36399 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36400 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36401 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36402 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36403 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36404 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36405 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36406 &`H `& host name and IP address
36407 &`I `& local interface used
36408 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36409 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36410 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36411 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36412 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36413 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36414 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36415 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36416 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36417 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36418 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36419 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36420 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36421 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36422 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36423 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36424 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36425 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36426 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36427 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36428 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36432 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36433 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36434 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36437 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36438 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36439 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36440 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36441 during the first delivery attempt.
36443 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36444 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36445 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36447 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36448 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36449 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36450 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36451 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36454 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36455 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36458 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36459 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36461 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36462 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36464 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36465 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36466 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36470 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36473 .cindex DKIM "log line"
36474 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36475 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36482 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36483 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36484 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36485 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36486 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36489 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36491 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36492 selection marked by asterisks:
36494 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36495 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36496 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36497 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36498 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36499 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36500 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36501 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36502 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36503 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36504 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36505 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36506 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36507 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36508 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36509 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36510 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36511 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36512 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36513 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36514 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36515 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36516 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36517 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36518 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36519 &` pid `& Exim process id
36520 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36521 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
36522 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36523 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36524 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36525 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36526 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36527 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36528 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36529 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36530 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36531 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36532 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36533 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36534 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36535 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36536 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36537 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36538 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36539 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36540 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36541 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36542 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36543 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36545 &` all `& all of the above
36547 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36548 section &<<SECID99>>&
36550 More details on each of these items follows:
36554 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36555 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36556 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36557 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36558 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36559 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36561 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36562 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36563 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36564 this log selector is set.
36566 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36567 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36568 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36569 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36570 such users cannot access the log).
36572 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36573 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36574 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36575 parentheses between them.
36577 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36578 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36579 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36580 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36581 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36582 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36583 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36584 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36585 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36586 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36587 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36588 between the caller and Exim.
36590 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36591 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36592 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36594 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36595 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36596 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36597 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36598 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36599 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36601 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36602 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36603 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36604 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36605 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36607 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36608 .cindex "size" "of message"
36609 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36610 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36612 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36613 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36614 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36615 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36617 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36618 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36619 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36621 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36622 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36623 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36624 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36625 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36628 .cindex dnssec logging
36629 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36630 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36631 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36632 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36633 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36635 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36636 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36637 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36638 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36639 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36640 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36642 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36643 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36644 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36645 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36646 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36648 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36649 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36650 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36651 client's ident port times out.
36653 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36654 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36655 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36656 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36657 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36658 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36659 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36660 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36661 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36662 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36663 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36665 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36666 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36667 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36668 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36669 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36670 on a proxied connection
36671 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36672 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36674 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36675 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36676 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36677 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36678 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36679 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36680 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36681 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36682 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36683 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36684 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36686 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36687 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36688 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36690 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36691 .cindex millisecond logging
36692 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36693 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36694 appended to the seconds value.
36696 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36697 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36698 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36699 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36700 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36701 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36702 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36703 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36704 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36706 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36707 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36708 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36709 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36710 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36711 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36712 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36713 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36714 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36715 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36717 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36718 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36719 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36720 immediately after the time and date.
36722 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36723 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36724 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36726 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36727 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36728 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36729 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36730 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36731 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36732 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36733 message has been successfully received.
36734 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36735 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36737 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36738 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36739 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36740 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36742 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
36743 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36744 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36745 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36746 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36748 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36749 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36750 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36751 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36752 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36754 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36757 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36758 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36759 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36760 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36762 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36763 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36764 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36765 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36766 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36768 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36769 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36770 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36771 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36774 .cindex "log" "return path"
36775 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36776 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36777 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36778 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36780 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36781 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36782 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36783 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36784 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36786 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36787 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36788 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36789 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36792 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36793 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36796 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36797 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36798 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36799 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36801 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36802 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36804 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36805 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36806 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36807 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36808 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36809 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36812 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36813 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36814 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36815 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36816 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36817 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36818 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36819 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36820 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36821 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36823 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36824 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36825 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36826 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36827 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36828 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36829 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36830 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36832 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36833 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36834 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36835 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36836 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36837 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36839 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36840 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36841 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36842 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36843 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36844 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36845 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36846 already have their own log lines.
36848 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36849 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36850 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36851 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36852 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36853 the same logging options.
36855 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36856 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36860 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36861 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36862 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36863 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36864 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36866 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36867 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36868 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36869 was accepted or used.
36871 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36872 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36873 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36874 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36875 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36876 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36877 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36878 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36880 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36881 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36882 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36883 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36884 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36885 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36886 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36887 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36888 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36890 .cindex "log" "subject"
36891 .cindex "subject, logging"
36892 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36893 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36894 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36895 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36896 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36898 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36900 .cindex DANE logging
36901 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36902 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36904 using a CA trust anchor,
36905 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
36906 and &`CV=no`& if not.
36908 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36909 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36910 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36911 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36913 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36914 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36915 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36916 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36917 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36919 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36920 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36921 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36922 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36923 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36925 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36926 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36927 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36931 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36932 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36933 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36934 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36935 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36936 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36937 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36938 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36939 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36940 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36941 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36942 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36943 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36945 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36946 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36947 &%message_logs%& option false.
36953 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36954 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36956 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36957 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36958 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36959 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36960 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36962 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36963 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36964 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36965 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36966 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36967 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36968 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36970 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36971 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36972 "extract statistics from the log"
36973 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36974 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36975 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36976 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36977 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36978 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36979 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36980 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36983 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36984 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36985 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36990 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36991 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36992 .cindex "process, querying"
36994 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36995 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36996 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36997 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36998 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36999 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37000 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37001 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37003 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37004 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37005 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37008 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37009 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37010 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37011 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37012 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37015 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37016 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37017 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37018 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37020 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37022 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37023 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37024 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37025 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37026 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37027 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37029 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37030 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37034 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37035 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37036 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37037 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37041 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37045 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37046 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37048 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37049 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37052 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37053 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37054 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37058 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37059 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37060 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37062 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37063 Match against the size field.
37065 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37066 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37068 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37069 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37072 Match only frozen messages.
37075 Match only non-frozen messages.
37078 The following options control the format of the output:
37082 Display only the count of matching messages.
37085 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37089 Display message ids only.
37092 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37095 Display messages in reverse order.
37098 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37101 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37105 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37106 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37107 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37108 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37109 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37110 running a command such as
37112 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37114 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37115 it, as in the following example:
37117 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37119 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37120 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37121 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37122 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37124 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37125 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37126 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37127 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37128 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37129 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37132 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37133 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37134 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37135 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37136 level"& addresses).
37141 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37143 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37144 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37145 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37146 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37147 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37148 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37149 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37150 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37151 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37152 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37154 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37156 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37158 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37159 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37160 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37162 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37163 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37164 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37165 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37166 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37168 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37169 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37170 regular expression.
37172 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37173 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37175 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37176 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37180 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37181 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37182 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37183 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37184 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37185 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37188 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37189 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37190 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37191 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37192 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37195 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37196 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37197 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37198 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37199 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37200 the &%--help%& option.
37203 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37204 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37205 .cindex "cycling logs"
37206 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37207 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37208 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37209 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37210 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37211 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37212 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37214 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37215 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37217 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37218 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37219 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37223 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37224 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37225 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37226 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37227 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37228 logs are handled similarly.
37230 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37231 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37232 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37233 any existing log files.
37235 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37236 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37237 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37238 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37239 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37241 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37243 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37244 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37248 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37249 .cindex "statistics"
37250 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37251 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37252 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37253 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
37254 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
37256 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37257 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37258 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37259 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37260 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37262 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37264 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37265 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37266 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37267 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37268 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37269 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37270 also produced per user.
37272 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37273 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37274 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37275 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37276 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37278 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37279 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37280 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37281 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37282 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37283 an entirely separate message.
37285 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37286 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37287 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37288 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37289 least one address that failed.
37291 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37292 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37293 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37294 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37295 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37296 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37297 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37299 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37300 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37301 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37303 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37304 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37305 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37307 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37310 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37311 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37312 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37313 .cindex "checking access"
37314 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37315 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37316 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37317 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37318 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37319 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37321 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37322 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37324 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37326 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37327 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37328 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37329 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37332 550 Relay not permitted
37334 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37335 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37336 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37337 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37340 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37341 -f himself@there.example
37343 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37344 mandatory arguments.
37346 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37347 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37348 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37352 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37353 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37354 .cindex "building DBM files"
37355 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37356 .cindex "lower casing"
37357 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37358 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37359 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37360 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37361 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37362 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37364 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37365 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37366 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37367 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37370 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37371 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37372 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37376 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37377 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37378 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37379 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37381 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37383 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37384 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37386 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37387 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37388 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37389 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37390 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37391 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37393 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37394 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37395 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37396 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37397 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37398 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37399 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37405 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37406 .cindex "retry" "times"
37407 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37408 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37409 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37410 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37411 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37412 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37413 output. For example:
37415 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37416 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37417 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37418 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37419 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37420 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37421 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37422 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37423 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37424 past final cutoff time
37426 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37427 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37428 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37429 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37430 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37431 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37434 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37435 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37436 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37437 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37438 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37439 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37443 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37444 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37445 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37446 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37447 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37448 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37449 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37452 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37454 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37457 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37459 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37461 &'misc'&: other hints data
37464 The &'misc'& database is used for
37467 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37469 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37470 &(smtp)& transport)
37472 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37478 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37479 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37480 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37481 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37482 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37484 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37486 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37488 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37489 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37491 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37492 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37493 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37494 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37495 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37496 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37497 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37498 and a textual description of the error.
37500 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37501 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37502 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37505 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37506 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37507 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37508 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37509 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37510 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37515 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37516 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37517 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37518 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37519 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37520 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37521 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37522 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37523 updated sufficiently often.
37525 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37526 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37527 the retry database:
37529 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37531 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37532 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37533 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37534 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37535 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37536 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37537 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37538 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37539 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37540 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37541 whenever it removes information from the database.
37543 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37544 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37545 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37546 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37547 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37549 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37550 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37551 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37552 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37553 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37554 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37555 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37558 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37559 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37564 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37565 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37566 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37567 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37568 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37569 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37570 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37573 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37574 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37575 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37576 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37577 by new data, for example:
37581 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37582 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37583 used as optional separators.
37588 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37589 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37590 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37591 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37592 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37593 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37594 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37595 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37596 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37597 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37598 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37599 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37600 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37604 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37607 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37610 .vitem &%-interval%&
37611 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37612 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37614 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37615 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37618 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37621 Suppress verification output.
37623 .vitem &%-retries%&
37624 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37625 the lock (default 10).
37627 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37628 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37629 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37630 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37633 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37634 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37635 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37636 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37639 Generate verbose output.
37642 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37643 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37644 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37645 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37646 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37647 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37648 more than 30 minutes old.
37650 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37651 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37652 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37653 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37654 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37655 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37657 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37658 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37659 suppresses all output except error messages.
37663 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37665 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37667 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37668 <&'some commands'&>
37671 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37672 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37675 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37676 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37678 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37679 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37686 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37687 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37688 .cindex "X-windows"
37689 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37690 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37691 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37692 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37693 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37694 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37695 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37696 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37700 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37701 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37702 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37703 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37704 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37705 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37706 parameters are for.
37708 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37709 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37710 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37712 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37714 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37715 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37716 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37717 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37718 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37720 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37721 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37723 Eximon*background: gray94
37725 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37726 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37727 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37728 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37729 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37730 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37731 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37734 Eximon*highlight: gray
37737 .cindex "admin user"
37738 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37739 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37741 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37742 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37743 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37744 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37745 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37747 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37748 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37749 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37750 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37751 different parts of the display.
37756 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37757 .cindex "stripchart"
37758 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37759 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37760 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37761 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37762 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37763 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37764 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37765 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37766 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37768 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37769 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37770 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37771 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37773 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37774 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37775 to a single partition.
37777 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37778 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37779 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37780 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37781 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37782 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37783 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37788 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37789 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37790 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37791 .cindex "window size"
37792 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37793 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37794 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37795 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37796 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37797 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37799 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37800 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37801 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37802 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37804 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37805 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37806 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37807 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37808 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37809 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37811 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37812 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37813 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37817 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37818 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37819 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37820 the main log is maintained.
37821 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37822 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37823 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37824 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37825 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37827 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37828 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37829 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37830 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37831 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37832 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37833 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37834 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37835 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37836 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37837 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37839 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37840 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37841 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37842 It cannot go further back up the log.
37844 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37845 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37846 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37847 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37848 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37849 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37851 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37852 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37853 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37854 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37855 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37856 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37858 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37859 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37860 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37861 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37862 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37863 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37864 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37865 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37866 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37871 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37872 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37873 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37874 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37875 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37876 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37877 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37878 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37879 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37880 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37882 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37883 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37884 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37885 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37886 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37887 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37888 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37890 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37891 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37892 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37893 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37894 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37895 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37896 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37898 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37899 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37900 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37901 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37903 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37904 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37905 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37906 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37907 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37908 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37909 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37912 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37913 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37915 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37916 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37917 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37918 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37919 display is updated.
37923 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37924 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37925 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37926 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37927 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37930 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37931 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37932 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37933 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37934 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37936 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37938 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37942 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37943 in a new text window.
37945 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37946 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37947 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37949 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37950 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37951 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37952 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37954 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37955 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37956 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37957 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37958 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37960 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37961 that the message be frozen.
37963 .cindex "thawing messages"
37964 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37965 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37966 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37967 that the message be thawed.
37969 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37970 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37971 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37972 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37974 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37975 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37978 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37979 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37980 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37981 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37982 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37983 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37984 which case no action is taken.
37986 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37987 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37988 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37989 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37990 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37991 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37992 case no action is taken.
37994 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37995 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37997 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37998 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37999 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38000 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38001 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38002 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38003 the address is qualified with that domain.
38006 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38007 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38008 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38009 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38010 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38011 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38012 if no output is generated.
38014 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38015 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38016 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38017 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38019 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38020 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38021 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38028 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38029 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38031 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38032 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38033 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38034 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38036 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38037 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38038 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38039 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38040 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38041 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38043 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38044 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38045 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38046 as soon as possible.
38049 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38050 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38051 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38052 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38053 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38054 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38057 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38058 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
38059 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
38060 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38061 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38062 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38064 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38065 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38066 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38067 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38070 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38071 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38072 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38073 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38074 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38075 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38076 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38077 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38078 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38082 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38083 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38084 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38085 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38086 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38087 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38088 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38090 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38093 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38094 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38095 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38096 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38097 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38102 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38104 .cindex "root privilege"
38105 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38106 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38107 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38108 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38109 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38110 is required for two things:
38113 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38114 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38117 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38118 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38122 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38123 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38124 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38125 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38126 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38127 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38128 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38129 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38131 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38132 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38133 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38135 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38136 uid and gid in the following cases:
38141 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38142 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38143 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38144 the calling process.
38145 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38146 option may not be used at all.
38147 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38148 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38149 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38154 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38155 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38158 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38159 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38160 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38161 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38162 testing address verification
38165 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38168 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38169 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38172 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38175 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38176 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38177 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38178 will be used during message reception.
38180 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38181 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38183 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38184 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38185 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38186 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38187 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38188 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38189 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38190 generating bounce and warning messages.
38192 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38193 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38194 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38195 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38197 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38198 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38204 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38205 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38206 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38207 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38208 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38209 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38210 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38211 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38212 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38213 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38217 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38218 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38219 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38220 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38222 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38223 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38224 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38225 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38226 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38228 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38229 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38230 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38233 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38234 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38235 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38237 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38238 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38239 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38240 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38241 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38242 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38243 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38244 address this problem at this time.
38246 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38247 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38248 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38249 be used in the most straightforward way.
38251 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38252 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38255 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38256 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38257 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38258 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38259 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38261 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38262 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38264 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38265 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38266 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38267 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38269 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38270 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38273 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38274 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38275 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38277 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38278 owned by the Exim user.
38280 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38281 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38282 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38287 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38288 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38289 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38290 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38292 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38293 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38298 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38299 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38300 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38304 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38305 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38306 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38307 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38308 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38309 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38310 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38313 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38314 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38315 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38316 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38317 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38319 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38320 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38321 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38322 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38323 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38324 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38325 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38327 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38328 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38329 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38331 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38332 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38334 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38335 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38336 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38338 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38339 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38340 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38342 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38343 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38344 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38345 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38351 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38352 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38353 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38354 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38355 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38356 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38357 are some issues to be aware of:
38360 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38362 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38364 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38365 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38366 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38367 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38368 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38369 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38372 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38373 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38374 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38376 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38377 expected to yield one result.
38383 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38384 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38385 .cindex "IP source routing"
38386 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38387 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38388 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38389 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38393 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38394 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38395 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38400 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38401 .cindex "trusted users"
38402 .cindex "admin user"
38403 .cindex "privileged user"
38404 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38405 .cindex "user" "admin"
38406 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38407 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38408 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38409 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38410 permit a remote host to be specified.
38413 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38414 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38415 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38416 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38417 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38418 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38420 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38421 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38422 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38423 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38424 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38426 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38427 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38428 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38429 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38430 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38434 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38435 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38436 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38437 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38438 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38439 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38441 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38442 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38443 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38444 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38445 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38446 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38449 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38450 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38451 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38452 This affects most of the checking options,
38453 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38456 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38457 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38458 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38459 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38460 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38461 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38465 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38466 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38467 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38468 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38469 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38474 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38475 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38476 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38477 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38482 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38483 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38484 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38485 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38486 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38490 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38491 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38492 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38496 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38497 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38498 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38499 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38500 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38501 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38502 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38504 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38505 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38510 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38511 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38512 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38513 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38517 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38518 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38519 enough to hold the result.
38520 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38528 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38529 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38530 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38531 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38532 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38533 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38534 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38535 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38536 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38537 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38538 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38539 themselves are recoverable.
38541 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38542 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38543 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38546 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38547 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38548 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38549 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38550 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38552 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38553 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38554 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38555 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38557 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38559 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38562 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38564 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38565 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38566 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38567 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38568 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38569 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38570 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38571 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38574 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38575 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38576 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38577 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38579 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38580 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38581 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38582 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38583 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38584 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38585 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38586 normally the Exim user.
38588 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38589 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38590 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38591 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38592 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38593 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38594 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38595 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38597 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38598 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38599 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38600 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38602 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38603 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38606 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38607 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38608 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38609 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38610 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38611 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38612 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38613 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38614 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38617 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38618 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38619 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38620 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38621 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38622 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38624 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38625 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38626 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38627 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38628 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38629 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38631 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38632 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38633 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38635 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38636 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38637 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38638 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38639 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38641 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38642 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38643 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38644 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38645 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38647 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38648 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38649 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38651 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38652 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38653 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38655 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38656 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38657 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38659 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38660 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38661 present if the number is greater than zero.
38663 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38664 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38665 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38667 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38668 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38669 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38671 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38672 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38675 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38676 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38677 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38680 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38681 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38682 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38683 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38685 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38686 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38687 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38689 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38690 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38691 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38692 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38693 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38694 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38696 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38697 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38698 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38699 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38700 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38702 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38703 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38704 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38705 generated messages.
38708 The message is from a local sender.
38710 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38711 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38713 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38714 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38715 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38716 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38718 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38719 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38720 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38723 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38724 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38727 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38728 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38729 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38731 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38732 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38733 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38735 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38736 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38737 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38739 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38740 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38741 rather than Unix-format.
38742 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38743 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38745 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38746 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38747 certificate was verified by the server.
38749 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38750 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38751 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38753 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38754 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38755 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38759 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38760 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38761 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38762 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38763 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38764 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38765 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38766 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38767 addresses are complete.
38769 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38770 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38771 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38772 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38773 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38774 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38776 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38777 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38778 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38780 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38781 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38782 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38783 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38787 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38788 darcy@austen.fict.example
38790 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38792 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38793 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38794 line is of the following form:
38796 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38797 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38799 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38800 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38801 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38802 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38803 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38804 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38805 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38806 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38809 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38810 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38811 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38812 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38813 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38817 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38818 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38819 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38820 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38821 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38822 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38823 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38824 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38825 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38826 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38829 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38830 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38831 typical set of headers:
38833 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38834 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38835 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38836 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38837 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38838 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38839 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38840 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38841 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38842 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38843 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38845 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38846 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38847 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38848 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38849 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38850 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38852 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38853 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38854 an ASCII newline character.
38855 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38856 can have an alternate format.
38857 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38858 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38859 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38860 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38861 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38862 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38864 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38867 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38868 "DKIM and SPF Support"
38871 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
38873 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38874 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38875 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38876 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
38878 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
38879 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
38880 any original DKIM signature.
38882 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38883 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38885 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38887 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38888 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38889 (including transport filters)
38890 except cutthrough delivery.
38892 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38893 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38894 different signature contexts.
38897 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38898 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38899 Exim's standard controls.
38901 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38902 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
38904 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
38905 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
38906 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38907 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38909 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38910 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38911 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38912 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38915 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38916 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38917 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38918 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38922 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38923 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38925 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
38926 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38928 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38930 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38931 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38934 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
38935 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
38936 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
38937 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
38938 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
38940 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38941 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38943 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38944 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38945 After expansion, this can be a list.
38946 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38947 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38948 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
38949 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38951 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38952 This sets the key selector string.
38953 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38954 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38955 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38956 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38957 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
38958 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38960 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38961 This sets the private key to use.
38962 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38963 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38964 The result can either
38966 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
38968 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
38969 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
38971 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38974 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38975 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38979 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
38981 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
38982 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
38984 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
38985 for the DNS TXT record.
38986 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
38990 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
38991 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
38994 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38996 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38997 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39000 Support for EC keys is being developed under
39001 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
39002 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39003 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39004 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39005 for some transition period.
39006 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39009 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39011 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39012 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39015 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39017 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39018 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39021 Note that the format
39022 of Ed25519 keys in DNS has not yet been decided; this release supports
39023 both of the leading candidates at this time, a future release will
39024 probably drop support for whichever proposal loses.
39026 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39027 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39029 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39031 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39033 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39036 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39038 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39041 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39042 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39043 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39044 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39045 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39046 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39048 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39049 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39050 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39051 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39052 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39054 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39055 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39056 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39057 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39058 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39061 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39062 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39063 list of header names.
39064 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39065 in the message signature.
39066 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39067 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39068 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39069 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39071 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39072 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39073 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39075 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39076 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39078 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39079 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39080 name will be appended.
39083 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39084 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39087 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39088 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39089 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39090 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39091 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39094 .new The results of that verification are then made available to the
39095 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, &new(which can examine and modify them).
39096 By default, this ACL is called once for each
39097 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39098 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39099 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39100 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39101 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39103 To evaluate the &new(verification result) in the ACL
39104 a large number of expansion variables
39105 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39106 runtime of the ACL.
39108 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39109 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39110 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39111 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39113 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39114 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39115 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39116 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39117 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39118 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39121 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39123 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39124 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39125 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39127 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39129 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39130 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39131 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39133 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39136 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39137 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39139 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39140 for each matching signature.
39143 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39144 available (from most to least important):
39148 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39149 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39150 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39151 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39153 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39154 Within the DKIM ACL,
39155 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39157 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39158 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39160 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39161 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39163 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39164 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39166 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39169 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39170 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39171 hash-method or key-size:
39173 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39174 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39175 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39176 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39177 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39178 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39179 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39182 After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39183 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39185 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39186 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39187 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39189 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39190 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39192 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39193 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39195 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39196 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39197 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39199 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39200 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39201 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39202 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39205 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39207 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39208 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39209 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39210 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39212 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39213 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39214 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39215 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39217 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39218 The key record selector string.
39220 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39221 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39222 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39223 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39224 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39227 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39229 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39231 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39232 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39235 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39236 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39238 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39239 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39241 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39242 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39244 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39245 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39246 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39247 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39248 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39249 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39251 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39252 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39253 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39254 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39256 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39257 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39258 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39260 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39261 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39262 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39263 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39264 integer size comparisons against this value.
39265 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39267 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39268 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39270 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39271 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39273 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39274 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39276 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39277 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39280 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39281 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39284 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39285 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39287 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39288 Number of bits in the key.
39290 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39292 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39293 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39296 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39297 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39298 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39302 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39305 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39306 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39307 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39308 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39309 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39312 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39313 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39314 sender_domains = gmail.com
39315 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39319 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39320 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39322 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39323 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39324 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39325 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39328 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39329 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39330 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39331 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39334 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39335 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39336 for more information of what they mean.
39342 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39343 .cindex SPF verification
39345 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39346 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39347 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39349 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39350 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39352 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39353 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39354 &url(http://www.libspf2.org/).
39355 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
39356 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
39358 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39359 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39360 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39361 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39364 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39365 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
39366 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39367 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39368 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39372 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39375 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39376 domain in the envelope-from address.
39378 .vitem &%softfail%&
39379 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39383 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39386 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39387 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39388 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39390 .vitem &%permerror%&
39391 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39392 You may deny messages when this occurs.
39394 .vitem &%temperror%&
39395 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39396 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39399 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39400 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39401 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39402 short-circuit fashion.
39407 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39408 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39409 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39410 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39411 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39412 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39413 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39414 ip=$sender_host_address
39417 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39420 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
39422 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39423 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39424 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39425 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39426 it for logging purposes.
39428 .vitem &$spf_received$&
39429 .vindex &$spf_received$&
39430 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39431 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39432 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39433 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39435 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39436 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39438 .vitem &$spf_result$&
39439 .vindex &$spf_result$&
39440 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39441 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39444 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
39445 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
39446 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
39447 and required in order to obtain a result.
39449 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39450 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39451 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39452 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39456 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39457 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39458 .cindex SPF "best guess"
39459 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39460 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39461 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39463 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39464 for a description of what it means.
39466 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39467 of the spf one. For example:
39470 deny spf_guess = fail
39471 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39474 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39475 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39476 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39479 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39480 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39482 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39483 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39484 &%spf_guess%& option.
39485 For example, the following:
39488 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39491 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39494 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39496 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39497 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39500 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39503 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
39504 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39505 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39511 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39513 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39515 .cindex "proxy support"
39516 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
39518 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39519 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39522 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39523 .cindex proxy inbound
39524 .cindex proxy "server side"
39525 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39526 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39528 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39529 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39530 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39533 It was built on specifications from:
39534 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
39535 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
39536 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
39538 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39539 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39540 to distribute load.
39541 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39542 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39543 There is no logging if a host passes or
39544 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39545 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39547 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39548 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39549 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39550 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39551 automatically determines which version is in use.
39553 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39554 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39555 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39556 Exim and the proxy server.
39558 The following expansion variables are usable
39559 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39562 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39563 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39564 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39565 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39566 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39568 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39569 there was a protocol error.
39571 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39572 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39573 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39574 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39575 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39576 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39577 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39578 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39579 A possible solution is:
39581 # Set max number of connections per host
39583 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39584 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39586 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39587 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39592 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39593 .cindex proxy outbound
39594 .cindex proxy "client side"
39595 .cindex proxy SOCKS
39596 .cindex SOCKS proxy
39597 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39598 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39599 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39602 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39603 on an smtp transport.
39604 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39605 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39606 Each proxy specifier is a list
39607 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
39608 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39610 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39611 The list of options is in the following table:
39613 &'auth '& authentication method
39614 &'name '& authentication username
39615 &'pass '& authentication password
39617 &'tmo '& connection timeout
39619 &'weight '& selection bias
39622 More details on each of these options follows:
39625 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
39626 .cindex proxy authentication
39627 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39628 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39629 for access to the proxy.
39630 Default is &"none"&.
39632 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39635 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39638 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39641 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39644 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39645 higher values being tried first.
39646 The default priority is 1.
39648 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39649 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39650 weighted by this value.
39651 The default value for selection bias is 1.
39654 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39655 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39656 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39658 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
39659 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39660 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39661 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39666 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39667 "Internationalisation""
39668 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
39671 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39673 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39674 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39675 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39677 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39678 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39679 requirement, upon libidn2.
39681 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39682 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39683 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39684 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39685 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39686 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39688 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39689 international handling for the message is enabled and
39690 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39692 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39693 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39694 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39695 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39697 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39698 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39699 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39700 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39702 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39703 components expanded to a-label form,
39704 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39707 .cindex log protocol
39708 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39709 .cindex i18n logging
39710 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39711 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39713 The following expansion operators can be used:
39715 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39716 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39717 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39718 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39721 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
39722 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
39724 may use the following modifier:
39726 control = utf8_downconvert
39727 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39729 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39730 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39731 Message Submission Agent context.
39732 If a value is appended it may be:
39734 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39735 &`0 `& no downconversion
39736 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39739 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39740 is initially set to -1.
39743 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39744 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39745 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39747 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39748 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39749 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39751 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39752 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39756 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39757 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39758 the following expansion operator can be used:
39760 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39763 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39764 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39765 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39767 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39768 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
39769 (which has to be a single character)
39770 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39771 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39773 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39774 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39776 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39777 by many other IMAP servers.
39781 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39782 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39783 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39786 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39787 must be representable in UTF-16.
39790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39793 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39797 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39798 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39799 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39800 processing actions.
39802 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39803 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39804 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39806 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39807 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39808 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39810 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39811 An example might look like:
39812 .cindex logging custom
39814 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39815 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39816 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39817 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39818 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39819 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39820 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39821 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39822 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39826 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39827 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39828 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39830 The current list of events is:
39832 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
39833 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39834 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39835 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39836 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39837 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39838 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39839 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39840 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39841 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39842 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39843 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39845 New event types may be added in future.
39847 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39848 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39849 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39851 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39852 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39853 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39855 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
39856 should define the event action.
39858 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39859 with the event type:
39861 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
39862 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39863 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39864 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39865 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39866 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39867 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39870 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39872 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39873 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39874 the course of its processing:
39876 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39879 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39880 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39882 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39883 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39885 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39886 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39887 following will be forced:
39889 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39890 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39891 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39893 All other message types ignore the result string, and
39894 no other use is made of it.
39896 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39897 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39900 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39901 chain element received on the connection.
39902 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39908 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39909 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39910 .cindex "adding drivers"
39911 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39912 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39913 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39914 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39917 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39918 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39920 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39922 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39924 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39925 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39926 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39928 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39930 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39933 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39934 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39936 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39937 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39938 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39939 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39940 simple form that most lookups have.
39942 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39943 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39944 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39946 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39949 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39950 as for other drivers and lookups.
39953 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39954 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39955 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39956 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39957 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39959 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39960 the interface that is expected.
39965 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39968 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39969 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39970 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39971 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39973 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39978 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39979 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39983 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39984 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39985 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39988 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39989 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////